blob: 289e99a34187979abbd6cdcc8d548ed3f9c2fb70 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau16216822012-09-10 09:46:55 +02007 2012/09/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200637.1. Matching integers
647.2. Matching strings
657.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200667.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200677.5. Available matching criteria
687.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
697.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
707.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
717.6. Pre-defined ACLs
727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100737.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074
758. Logging
768.1. Log levels
778.2. Log formats
788.2.1. Default log format
798.2.2. TCP log format
808.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100818.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200828.3. Advanced logging options
838.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
848.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
858.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
868.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
878.4. Timing events
888.5. Session state at disconnection
898.6. Non-printable characters
908.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
918.8. Capturing HTTP headers
928.9. Examples of logs
93
949. Statistics and monitoring
959.1. CSV format
969.2. Unix Socket commands
97
98
991. Quick reminder about HTTP
100----------------------------
101
102When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
103fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
104on almost anything found in the contents.
105
106However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
107formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
108correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
109
110
1111.1. The HTTP transaction model
112-------------------------------
113
114The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100115to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
117connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
118will involve a new connection :
119
120 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
121
122In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
123establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
124by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
125length.
126
127Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
128to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
129however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
130response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
131header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
132
133 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
134
135Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
136power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
137but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200138a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139
140A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
141keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
142second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
143page :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
148latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
149correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
150the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100151server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200153By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
154connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
155everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
156established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
157sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
158while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
159another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
160sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
161http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
162mode.
163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
1651.2. HTTP request
166-----------------
167
168First, let's consider this HTTP request :
169
170 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100171 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
173 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
174 3 User-agent: my small browser
175 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
176 5 Accept: image/png
177
178
1791.2.1. The Request line
180-----------------------
181
182Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
183
184 - a METHOD : GET
185 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
186 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
187
188All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
189which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
190followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
191is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
192desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
193the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
194
195The URI itself can have several forms :
196
197 - A "relative URI" :
198
199 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200
201 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
202 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
203
204 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
205
206 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
207
208 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
209 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
210 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
211 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
212 must accept this form too.
213
214 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
215 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
216 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
219 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
220 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
221 other protocols too.
222
223In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
224mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
225on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
226It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
227specific to the language, framework or application in use.
228
229
2301.2.2. The request headers
231--------------------------
232
233The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
234beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
235an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
236Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
237values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
238encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
239the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
240define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
241
242Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
243their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
244"Connection:" header).
245
246The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
247that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
248is one valid form of empty line.
249
250Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
251headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
252about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
253application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
254
255Important note:
256 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
257 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
258 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
259 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
260
261
2621.3. HTTP response
263------------------
264
265An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
266messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
267
268 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100269 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
271 2 Content-length: 350
272 3 Content-Type: text/html
273
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200274As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
275codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
276response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100277continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
278the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
279following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
280sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
281(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
282correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
283such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
284state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
285over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
286if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
287information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200289
2901.3.1. The Response line
291------------------------
292
293Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
294
295 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
296 - a status code : 200
297 - a reason : OK
298
299The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200300 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
302 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
303 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
304 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
305
306Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100307"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
309messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
310or "Authentication Required".
311
312Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
313
314 Code When / reason
315 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
316 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
318 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
319 400 for an invalid or too large request
320 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
321 accessing the stats page)
322 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
323 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
324 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
325 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
326 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
327 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
328 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
329 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
330 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
331
332The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3334.2).
334
335
3361.3.2. The response headers
337---------------------------
338
339Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
340the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
341details.
342
343
3442. Configuring HAProxy
345----------------------
346
3472.1. Configuration file format
348------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200349
350HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
351
352 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
353 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
354 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
355 "frontend" and "backend".
356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
358referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
359delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100360preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100361escaped by doubling them.
362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363
3642.2. Time format
365----------------
366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
369otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
370numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
371for every keyword. Supported units are :
372
373 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
374 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
375 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
376 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
377 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
378 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
379
380
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003812.3. Examples
382-------------
383
384 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
385 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
386 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
387 global
388 daemon
389 maxconn 256
390
391 defaults
392 mode http
393 timeout connect 5000ms
394 timeout client 50000ms
395 timeout server 50000ms
396
397 frontend http-in
398 bind *:80
399 default_backend servers
400
401 backend servers
402 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
403
404
405 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
406 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
407 global
408 daemon
409 maxconn 256
410
411 defaults
412 mode http
413 timeout connect 5000ms
414 timeout client 50000ms
415 timeout server 50000ms
416
417 listen http-in
418 bind *:80
419 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
420
421
422Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
423
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100424 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200425
426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004273. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200428--------------------
429
430Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
431are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
432of them have command-line equivalents.
433
434The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
435
436 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200437 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200439 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200440 - daemon
441 - gid
442 - group
443 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100444 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - nbproc
446 - pidfile
447 - uid
448 - ulimit-n
449 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200450 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200451 - node
452 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100453 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100454
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 * Performance tuning
456 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200457 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100458 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100459 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200460 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200461 - noepoll
462 - nokqueue
463 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100464 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200465 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200466 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200467 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100468 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200469 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100470 - tune.maxaccept
471 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200472 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200473 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100474 - tune.rcvbuf.client
475 - tune.rcvbuf.server
476 - tune.sndbuf.client
477 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100478 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100479 - tune.zlib.memlevel
480 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100481
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200482 * Debugging
483 - debug
484 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200485
486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004873.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200488------------------------------------
489
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200490ca-base <dir>
491 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200492 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
493 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200494
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200495chroot <jail dir>
496 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
497 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
498 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
499 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
500 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
501 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100502
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100503cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
504 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
505 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
506 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
507 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
508 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
509 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
510 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
511 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
512 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
513 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
514 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
515 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
516 they overlap.
517
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200518crt-base <dir>
519 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
520 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
521 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
522
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200523daemon
524 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
525 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
526 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
527
528gid <number>
529 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
530 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
531 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
532 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100533
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200534group <group name>
535 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
536 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100537
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200538log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200539 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
540 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100541 configured with "log global".
542
543 <address> can be one of:
544
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100545 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100546 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
547 port).
548
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100549 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
550 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
551 port).
552
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100553 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
554 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
555 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
556 writeable).
557
558 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200559
560 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
561 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
562 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
563
564 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200565 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
566 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
567 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
568 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
569 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
570 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200571
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200572 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100574log-send-hostname [<string>]
575 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
576 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
577 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
578 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
579 the logs.
580
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000581log-tag <string>
582 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
583 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
584 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
585 running on the same host.
586
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587nbproc <number>
588 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
589 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
590 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
591 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
592 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
593
594pidfile <pidfile>
595 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
596 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
597 starting the process. See also "daemon".
598
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100599stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200600 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
601 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
602 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
603 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
604 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
605 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
606 the number of processes used.
607
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200608stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
609 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
610 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
611 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
612 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200613
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200614 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
615 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
616 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200617
618stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
619 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
620 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100621 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200622
623stats maxconn <connections>
624 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
625 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
626
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627uid <number>
628 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
629 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
630 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
631 one. See also "gid" and "user".
632
633ulimit-n <number>
634 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
635 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
636 option.
637
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100638unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
639 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
640
641 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
642 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
643 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
644 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
645 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
646 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
647 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
648 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
649 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
650 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
651
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200652user <user name>
653 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
654 See also "uid" and "group".
655
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200656node <name>
657 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
658
659 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
660 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
661 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
662 traffic.
663
664description <text>
665 Add a text that describes the instance.
666
667 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
668 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
669 "<" and ">" characters.
670
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006723.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200673-----------------------
674
675maxconn <number>
676 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
677 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
678 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
679 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
680
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200681maxconnrate <number>
682 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
683 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
684 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
685 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
686 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
687 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
688 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
689 fairness.
690
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100691maxcomprate <number>
692 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
693 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
694 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
695 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
696 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
697 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
698 default value.
699
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100700maxpipes <number>
701 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
702 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
703 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
704 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
705 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
706 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
707
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200708maxsslconn <number>
709 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
710 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
711 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
712 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
713 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
714 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
715 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
716
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100717maxzlibmem <number>
718 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
719 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
720 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
721 The default value is 0.
722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723noepoll
724 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
725 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100726 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200727
728nokqueue
729 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
730 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
731 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
732
733nopoll
734 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
735 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100736 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100737 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200738
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100739nosplice
740 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
741 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
742 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100743 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100744 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
745 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
746 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
747 "option splice-response".
748
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200749spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
750 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
751 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
752 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
753 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
754 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
755
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200756tune.bufsize <number>
757 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
758 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
759 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
760 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
761 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
762 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
763 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
764 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400765 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
766 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
767 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200768
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200769tune.chksize <number>
770 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
771 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
772 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
773 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
774 checks whenever possible.
775
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100776tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
777 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
778 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
779 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
780 this value. The default value is 1.
781
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200782tune.http.maxhdr <number>
783 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
784 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
785 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
786 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
787 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
788 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
789 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
790 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
791 limit too high.
792
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100793tune.maxaccept <number>
794 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
795 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
796 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100797 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100798 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
799 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100800 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100801 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
802
803tune.maxpollevents <number>
804 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
805 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
806 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
807 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
808 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
809
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200810tune.maxrewrite <number>
811 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
812 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
813 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
814 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
815 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
816 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
817 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
818 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
819 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
820 bufsize.
821
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200822tune.pipesize <number>
823 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
824 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
825 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
826 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
827 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
828 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
829
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100830tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
831tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
832 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
833 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
834 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
835 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
836 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
837 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
838 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
839
840tune.sndbuf.client <number>
841tune.sndbuf.server <number>
842 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
843 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
844 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
845 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
846 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
847 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
848 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
849 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
850 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
851 notifying haproxy again.
852
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100853tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
854 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in number of sessions. Each
855 entry uses approximately 600 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced
856 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
857 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
858 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
859 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-
860 allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is
861 greater than 1.
862
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100863tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
864 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
865 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
866 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
867 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
868 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
869 being used for too long.
870
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100871tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
872 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
873 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
874 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
875 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
876 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
877
878tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
879 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
880 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
881 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
882 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008843.3. Debugging
885--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200886
887debug
888 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
889 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
890 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
891 system startup.
892
893quiet
894 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
895 line argument "-q".
896
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008983.4. Userlists
899--------------
900It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
901http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
902it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
903
904userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100905 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100906 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
907
908group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100909 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100910 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
911 proceeded by "users" keyword.
912
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100913user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
914 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100915 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
916 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100917 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
918 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100919 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
920 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
921
922
923 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100924 userlist L1
925 group G1 users tiger,scott
926 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100927
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100928 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
929 user scott insecure-password elgato
930 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100931
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100932 userlist L2
933 group G1
934 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100935
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100936 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
937 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
938 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100939
940 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200941
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200942
9433.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200944----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200945It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
946haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
947pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
948identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
949or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
950Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
951known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
952the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
953process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
954during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
955tables.
956
957peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400958 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200959 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
960
961peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
962 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
963 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
964 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
965 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
966 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
967 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
968
969 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
970 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
971
972 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
973 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
974 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
975 across all peers.
976
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200977 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200978 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100979 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
980 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
981 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200982
983 backend mybackend
984 mode tcp
985 balance roundrobin
986 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
987 stick on src
988
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100989 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
990 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200991
992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009934. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100995
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200996Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
997 - defaults <name>
998 - frontend <name>
999 - backend <name>
1000 - listen <name>
1001
1002A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1003its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1004section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001005section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006
1007A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1008connections.
1009
1010A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1011to forward incoming connections.
1012
1013A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1014parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1015
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001016All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1017'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1018case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1019
1020Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1021logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1022proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1023However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1024name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1025
1026Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1027and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001028bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001029protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1030modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1031arbitrary criteria.
1032
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010344.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1035--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001036
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001037The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1038limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1039they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1040limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001041marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001042option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001043and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1044with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1045specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001046
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001047
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001048 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1049------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1050acl - X X X
1051appsession - - X X
1052backlog X X X -
1053balance X - X X
1054bind - X X -
1055bind-process X X X X
1056block - X X X
1057capture cookie - X X -
1058capture request header - X X -
1059capture response header - X X -
1060clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001061compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001062contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1063cookie X - X X
1064default-server X - X X
1065default_backend X X X -
1066description - X X X
1067disabled X X X X
1068dispatch - - X X
1069enabled X X X X
1070errorfile X X X X
1071errorloc X X X X
1072errorloc302 X X X X
1073-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1074errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001075force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001076fullconn X - X X
1077grace X X X X
1078hash-type X - X X
1079http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001080http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001081http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001082http-request - X X X
1083id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001084ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001085log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001086maxconn X X X -
1087mode X X X X
1088monitor fail - X X -
1089monitor-net X X X -
1090monitor-uri X X X -
1091option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1092option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1093option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1094option allbackups (*) X - X X
1095option checkcache (*) X - X X
1096option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1097option contstats (*) X X X -
1098option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1099option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1100option forceclose (*) X X X X
1101-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1102option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001103option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001104option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001105option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1106option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1107option httpchk X - X X
1108option httpclose (*) X X X X
1109option httplog X X X X
1110option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001111option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001112option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001113option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1114option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1115option logasap (*) X X X -
1116option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001117option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001118option nolinger (*) X X X X
1119option originalto X X X X
1120option persist (*) X - X X
1121option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001122option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001123option smtpchk X - X X
1124option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1125option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1126option splice-request (*) X X X X
1127option splice-response (*) X X X X
1128option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1129option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1130-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1131option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1132option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1133option tcpka X X X X
1134option tcplog X X X X
1135option transparent (*) X - X X
1136persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1137rate-limit sessions X X X -
1138redirect - X X X
1139redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1140redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1141reqadd - X X X
1142reqallow - X X X
1143reqdel - X X X
1144reqdeny - X X X
1145reqiallow - X X X
1146reqidel - X X X
1147reqideny - X X X
1148reqipass - X X X
1149reqirep - X X X
1150reqisetbe - X X X
1151reqitarpit - X X X
1152reqpass - X X X
1153reqrep - X X X
1154-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1155reqsetbe - X X X
1156reqtarpit - X X X
1157retries X - X X
1158rspadd - X X X
1159rspdel - X X X
1160rspdeny - X X X
1161rspidel - X X X
1162rspideny - X X X
1163rspirep - X X X
1164rsprep - X X X
1165server - - X X
1166source X - X X
1167srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001168stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001169stats auth X - X X
1170stats enable X - X X
1171stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001172stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001173stats realm X - X X
1174stats refresh X - X X
1175stats scope X - X X
1176stats show-desc X - X X
1177stats show-legends X - X X
1178stats show-node X - X X
1179stats uri X - X X
1180-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1181stick match - - X X
1182stick on - - X X
1183stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001184stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001185stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001186tcp-request connection - X X -
1187tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001188tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001189tcp-response content - - X X
1190tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001191timeout check X - X X
1192timeout client X X X -
1193timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1194timeout connect X - X X
1195timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1196timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1197timeout http-request X X X X
1198timeout queue X - X X
1199timeout server X - X X
1200timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1201timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001202timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001203transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001204unique-id-format X X X -
1205unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001206use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001207use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001208------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1209 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001210
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012124.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1213---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001214
1215This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1216
1217
1218acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1219 Declare or complete an access list.
1220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1221 no | yes | yes | yes
1222 Example:
1223 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1224 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1225 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001227 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001228
1229
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001230appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1231 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001232 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1234 no | no | yes | yes
1235 Arguments :
1236 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1237 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1238
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001239 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001240 checked in each cookie value.
1241
1242 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1243 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1244 milliseconds.
1245
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001246 request-learn
1247 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1248 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1249 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1250 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1251 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1252 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1253
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001254 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1255 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1256 data following this prefix.
1257
1258 Example :
1259 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1260
1261 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1262 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1263
1264 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1265 2 modes are currently supported :
1266 - path-parameters :
1267 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1268 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1269 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1270 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1271 - query-string :
1272 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1273 query string.
1274
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001275 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1276 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1277 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1278 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001279 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1280 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1281 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001282 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1283 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1284
1285 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1286
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001287 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1288 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1289 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1290
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001291 Example :
1292 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1293
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001294 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1295 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001296
1297
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001298backlog <conns>
1299 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1301 yes | yes | yes | no
1302 Arguments :
1303 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1304 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001305 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001306
1307 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1308 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1309 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1310 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1311 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1312 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1313 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1314 backlog parameter.
1315
1316 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1317 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1318 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1319
1320 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1321
1322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001323balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001324balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001325 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1327 yes | no | yes | yes
1328 Arguments :
1329 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1330 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1331 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1332 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1333
1334 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1335 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1336 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1337 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001338 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1339 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1340 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1341 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1342 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1343 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1344 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1345 it, so that you don't worry.
1346
1347 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1348 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1349 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1350 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1351 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1352 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1353 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1354 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001355
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001356 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1357 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1358 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1359 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1360 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1361 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1362 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1363 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1364
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001365 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1366 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1367 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1368 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001369 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001370 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1371 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1372 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1373 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1374 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001375 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1376 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1377 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1378 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1379 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1380 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001381
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001382 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1383 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1384 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1385 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1386 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1387 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1388 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1389 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001390 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001391 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001392 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1393 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1394 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001395
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001396 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1397 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1398 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1399 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1400 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1401 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1402 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1403 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1404 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1405 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1406 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1407 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001408
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001409 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001410 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1411 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1412 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1413 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1414 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1415 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1416 URIs start with a leading "/".
1417
1418 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1419 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1420 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1421 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1422
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001423 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001424 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1425
1426 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001427 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1428 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1429 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1430 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1431 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1432 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1433 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1434 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1435 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1436 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1437 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1438 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1439 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1440 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1441 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1442 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1443 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1444 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1445 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001446
1447 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1448 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1449 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1450 server will receive the request.
1451
1452 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1453 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1454 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1455 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1456 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001457 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1458 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1459 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001460
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001461 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1462 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1463 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1464 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1465 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001466
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001467 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001468 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1469 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1470 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1471
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001472 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1473 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1474 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1475
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001476 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001477 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001478 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1479 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1480 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1481 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1482 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1483 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001484 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001485 used instead.
1486
1487 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1488 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1489 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1490 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1491
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001492 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1493 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1494 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1495
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001496 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001498 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001499 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1500 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001501
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001502 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001503 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001504
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001505 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1506 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1507 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001508
1509 Examples :
1510 balance roundrobin
1511 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001512 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001513 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1514 balance hdr(host)
1515 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001516
1517 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1518 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1519
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001520 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001521 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1522 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1523 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1524 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1525
1526 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1527 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1528 defaults to 16 kB.
1529
1530 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1531 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1532
1533 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1534 Round Robin.
1535
1536 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1537 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1538 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1539 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1540
1541 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1542
1543 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001544 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001545 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1546 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1547 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001548
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001549 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1550 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001551
1552
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001553bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1554bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001555 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1557 no | yes | yes | no
1558 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001559 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1560 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1561 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1562 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001563 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001564
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001565 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1566 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001567 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1568 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1569 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001570 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1571 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1572 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1573 the range.
1574
1575 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1576 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1577 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1578 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1579 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1580 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1581 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001582 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001583 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001584
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001585 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1586 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1587 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1588 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1589 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1590 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1591 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1592 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1593
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001594 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1595 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1596 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1597 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001598
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001599 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1600 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1601 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1602 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1603 in a frontend.
1604
1605 Example :
1606 listen http_proxy
1607 bind :80,:443
1608 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001609 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001610
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001611 listen http_https_proxy
1612 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001613 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001614
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001615 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001616 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001617
1618
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001619bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001620 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1622 yes | yes | yes | yes
1623 Arguments :
1624 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1625 may be used to override a default value.
1626
1627 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1628 option may be combined with other numbers.
1629
1630 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1631 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1632 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1633 missing from all processes.
1634
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001635 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1636 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1637 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1638 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1639 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001640
1641 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1642 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1643 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1644 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1645 and 'even' instances.
1646
1647 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1648 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1649 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1650 32.
1651
1652 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1653 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1654
1655 Example :
1656 listen app_ip1
1657 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001658 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001659
1660 listen app_ip2
1661 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001662 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001663
1664 listen management
1665 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001666 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001667
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001668 listen management
1669 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1670 bind-process 1-4
1671
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001672 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1673
1674
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001675block { if | unless } <condition>
1676 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1678 no | yes | yes | yes
1679
1680 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1681 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001682 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001683 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001684 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1685 "block" statements per instance.
1686
1687 Example:
1688 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1689 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1690 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1691 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1692
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001693 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001694
1695
1696capture cookie <name> len <length>
1697 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1699 no | yes | yes | no
1700 Arguments :
1701 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1702 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1703 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1704 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1705 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1706
1707 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1708 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1709 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1710 right if it exceeds <length>.
1711
1712 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1713 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1714 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1715 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1716
1717 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1718 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1719 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1720
1721 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1722 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1723 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1724 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001725 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001726 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1727
1728 Example:
1729 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1730
1731 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001732 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001733
1734
1735capture request header <name> len <length>
1736 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1738 no | yes | yes | no
1739 Arguments :
1740 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001741 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001742 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1743 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1744 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1745
1746 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1747 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1748 it exceeds <length>.
1749
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001750 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001751 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1752 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001753 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1754 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1755 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1756 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001757 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001758 environments to find where the request came from.
1759
1760 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1761 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1762 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1763 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001764
1765 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1766 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1767 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1768 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1769
1770 Example:
1771 capture request header Host len 15
1772 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1773 capture request header Referrer len 15
1774
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001775 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001776 about logging.
1777
1778
1779capture response header <name> len <length>
1780 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1782 no | yes | yes | no
1783 Arguments :
1784 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001785 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001786 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1787 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1788 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1789
1790 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1791 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1792 it exceeds <length>.
1793
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001794 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001795 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1796 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1797 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001798 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1799 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1800 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1801 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001802
1803 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1804 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1805 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1806 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1807
1808 Example:
1809 capture response header Content-length len 9
1810 capture response header Location len 15
1811
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001812 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001813 about logging.
1814
1815
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001816clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001817 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1819 yes | yes | yes | no
1820 Arguments :
1821 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1822 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1823 as explained at the top of this document.
1824
1825 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1826 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1827 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1828 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1829 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1830 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1831 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1832 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001833 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001834 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1835 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1836
1837 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1838 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1839 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1840 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1841 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1842 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1843
1844 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1845 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1846
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001847 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1848 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001849
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001850compression algo <algorithm> ...
1851compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001852compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001853 Enable HTTP compression.
1854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1855 yes | yes | yes | yes
1856 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001857 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1858 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1859 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1860
1861 The currently supported algorithms are :
1862 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developping
1863 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1864 data.
1865
1866 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1867 support for zlib was built in.
1868
1869 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1870 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1871 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1872 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1873 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1874 in.
1875
1876 Compression will be activated depending of the Accept-Encoding request
1877 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001878
1879 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1880 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1881 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1882 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1883 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
1884 and need to prevent it from emitting invalid payloads. In this case, simply
1885 removing the header in the configuration does not work because it applies
1886 before the header is parsed, so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The
1887 "offload" setting should then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001888
1889 Examples :
1890 compression algo gzip
1891 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001892
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001893contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001894 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1896 yes | no | yes | yes
1897 Arguments :
1898 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1899 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1900 as explained at the top of this document.
1901
1902 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001903 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001904 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001905 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1906 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1907 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1908 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1909
1910 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1911 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1912 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1913 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1914 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1915 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1916
1917 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1918 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1919 instead.
1920
1921 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1922 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1923
1924
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001925cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001926 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1927 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001928 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1930 yes | no | yes | yes
1931 Arguments :
1932 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1933 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1934 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1935 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1936 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1937 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1938 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1939 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1940 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1941
1942 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1943 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1944 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1945 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1946 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1947 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1948 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1949 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1950 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1951 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1952 "insert" and "prefix".
1953
1954 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001955 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001956
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001957 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001958 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1959 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1960 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1961 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1962 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1963 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1964 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1965 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1966 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1967 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001968
1969 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1970 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1971 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1972 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1973 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1974 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1975 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1976 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1977 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1978 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001979 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1980 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1981 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001982
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001983 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1984 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1985 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001986 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1987 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1988 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1989 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001990 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1991 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1992 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001993
1994 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1995 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1996 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1997 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1998 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1999 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2000 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2001 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2002 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2003
2004 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2005 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2006 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2007 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2008 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2009 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2010 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2011 persistence cookie in the cache.
2012 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2013
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002014 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2015 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2016 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2017 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2018 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2019 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2020 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2021 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2022 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2023 they logout.
2024
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002025 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2026 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2027 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2028 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2029
2030 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2031 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2032 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2033 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2034 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2035 this attribute.
2036
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002037 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002038 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002039 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2040 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2041 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2042 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2043 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2044 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002045
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002046 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2047 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2048 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2049 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2050 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2051 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2052 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2053 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2054 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2055 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2056 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2057 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2058 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2059 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2060 the site.
2061
2062 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2063 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2064 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2065 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2066 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2067 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2068 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2069 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2070 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2071 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2072 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2073 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2074 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2075 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2076 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2077 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2078
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002079 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2080 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2081 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2082 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002083
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084 Examples :
2085 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2086 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2087 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002088 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002089
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002090 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002091 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002092
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002093
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002094default-server [param*]
2095 Change default options for a server in a backend
2096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2097 yes | no | yes | yes
2098 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002099 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2100 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2101 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2102 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002103
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002104 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002105 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2106
2107 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002108
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002109
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002110default_backend <backend>
2111 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2113 yes | yes | yes | no
2114 Arguments :
2115 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2116
2117 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2118 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2119 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2120 will catch all undetermined requests.
2121
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002122 Example :
2123
2124 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2125 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2126 default_backend dynamic
2127
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002128 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2129
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002130
2131disabled
2132 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2134 yes | yes | yes | yes
2135 Arguments : none
2136
2137 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2138 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2139 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2140 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2141 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2142 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2143 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2144
2145 See also : "enabled"
2146
2147
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002148dispatch <address>:<port>
2149 Set a default server address
2150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2151 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002152 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002153
2154 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2155 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2156 during start-up.
2157
2158 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2159 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2160 possible with normal servers.
2161
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002162 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002163 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2164 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2165 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2166 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2167
2168 See also : "server"
2169
2170
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002171enabled
2172 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2174 yes | yes | yes | yes
2175 Arguments : none
2176
2177 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2178 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2179
2180 See also : "disabled"
2181
2182
2183errorfile <code> <file>
2184 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2186 yes | yes | yes | yes
2187 Arguments :
2188 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002189 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002190
2191 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002192 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002193 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002194 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2195 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002196
2197 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2198 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2199 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2200
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002201 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2202
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002203 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2204 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2205 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2206 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2207
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002208 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2209 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2210 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2211 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2212 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2213 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2214
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002215 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2216 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2217 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002218 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002219 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2220
2221 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2222
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002223 Example :
2224 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2225 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2226 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2227
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002228
2229errorloc <code> <url>
2230errorloc302 <code> <url>
2231 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2233 yes | yes | yes | yes
2234 Arguments :
2235 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002236 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002237
2238 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2239 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2240 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2241 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2242 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2243
2244 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2245 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2246 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2247
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002248 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2249
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002250 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2251 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2252 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2253 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2254 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2255 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2256 request.
2257
2258 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2259
2260
2261errorloc303 <code> <url>
2262 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2264 yes | yes | yes | yes
2265 Arguments :
2266 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2267 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2268
2269 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2270 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2271 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2272 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2273 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2274
2275 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2276 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2277 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2278
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002279 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2280
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002281 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2282 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2283 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2284 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002285 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002286
2287 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2288
2289
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002290force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2291 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2292 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2293 no | yes | yes | yes
2294
2295 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2296 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2297 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2298 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2299 marked down for maintenance operations.
2300
2301 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2302 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2303 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2304 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2305 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2306 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2307 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2308 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2309 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2310
2311 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2312 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2313 is used.
2314
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002315 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002316 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002317
2318
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002319fullconn <conns>
2320 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2322 yes | no | yes | yes
2323 Arguments :
2324 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2325 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2326
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002327 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002328 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002329 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002330 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2331 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2332 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2333 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2334 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002335 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002336
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002337 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2338 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2339 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2340
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002341 Example :
2342 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2343 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2344 # connections.
2345 backend dynamic
2346 fullconn 10000
2347 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2348 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2349
2350 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2351
2352
2353grace <time>
2354 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002356 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002357 Arguments :
2358 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2359 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2360 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2361
2362 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2363 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002364 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002365 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2366
2367 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2368 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2369 simplify it.
2370
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002371
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002372hash-type <method>
2373 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2375 yes | no | yes | yes
2376 Arguments :
2377 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2378 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2379 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2380 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2381 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2382 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2383 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2384 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2385 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2386
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002387 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2388 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2389 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2390 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2391 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2392 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2393 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2394 this value.
2395
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002396 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2397 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2398 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2399 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2400 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2401 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2402 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2403 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2404 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2405 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2406 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2407 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2408 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2409
2410 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2411
2412 See also : "balance", "server"
2413
2414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002415http-check disable-on-404
2416 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002418 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002419 Arguments : none
2420
2421 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2422 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2423 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2424 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2425 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2426 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2427 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2428 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002429 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2430 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2431 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2432
2433 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2434
2435
2436http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002437 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002439 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002440 Arguments :
2441 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2442 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002443 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002444 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2445 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2446 details on the supported keywords.
2447
2448 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2449 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2450 with the usual backslash ('\').
2451
2452 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2453 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2454 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2455 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2456 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2457
2458 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002459 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002460 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2461 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2462 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2463
2464 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002465 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002466 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2467 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2468 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2469 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2470
2471 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002472 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002473 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2474 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2475 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2476 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2477 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2478 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2479 trace).
2480
2481 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002482 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002483 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2484 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2485 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2486 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2487 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2488 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2489
2490 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2491 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2492 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2493 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2494 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2495 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2496 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2497 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2498
2499 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2500 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2501
2502 Examples :
2503 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002504 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002505
2506 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002507 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002508
2509 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002510 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002511
2512 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002513 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002514
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002515 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002516
2517
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002518http-check send-state
2519 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2521 yes | no | yes | yes
2522 Arguments : none
2523
2524 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2525 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2526 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2527 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2528 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2529
2530 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2531 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2532 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2533 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2534 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2535 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2536 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2537 checked in multiple backends.
2538
2539 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2540 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2541
2542 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2543 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2544 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2545 one fails.
2546
2547 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2548 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2549 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2550
2551 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2552 server's queue.
2553
2554 Example of a header received by the application server :
2555 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2556 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2557
2558 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2559
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002560http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002561 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002562 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2563
2564 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2565 no | yes | yes | yes
2566
2567 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2568 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2569 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002570 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2571 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002572 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2573
2574 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2575 instance.
2576
2577 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002578 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2579 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2580 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002581
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002582 http-request allow if nagios
2583 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2584 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2585 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002586
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002587 Example:
2588 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002589
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002590 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002591
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002592 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2593 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002594
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002595http-send-name-header [<header>]
2596 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2597
2598 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2599 yes | no | yes | yes
2600
2601 Arguments :
2602
2603 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2604
2605 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2606 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2607 is added with the header string proved.
2608
2609 See also : "server"
2610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002611id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002612 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2614 no | yes | yes | yes
2615 Arguments : none
2616
2617 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2618 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2619 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002620
2621
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002622ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2623 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2624 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2625 no | yes | yes | yes
2626
2627 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2628 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2629 and running).
2630
2631 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2632 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2633 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2634 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2635 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2636
2637 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2638 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2639
2640 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2641 "unless" condition is met.
2642
2643 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2644
2645
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002646log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002647log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002648no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002649 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2651 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002652
2653 Prefix :
2654 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2655 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2656 prefix does not allow arguments.
2657
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002658 Arguments :
2659 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2660 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2661 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2662 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2663 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2664 parameter.
2665
2666 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2667 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2668
2669 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2670 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2671 standard syslog port).
2672
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002673 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2674 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2675 standard syslog port).
2676
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002677 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2678 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2679 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2680 appropriately writeable).
2681
2682 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2683
2684 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2685 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2686 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2687
2688 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2689 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2690 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002691 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2692 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2693 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2694 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2695 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002696
2697 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2698
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002699 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2700 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2701 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002702
2703 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2704 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2705 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2706 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2707
2708 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2709 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002710
2711 Example :
2712 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002713 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2714 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002715
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002716log-format <string>
2717 Allows you to custom a log line.
2718
2719 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2720
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002721
2722maxconn <conns>
2723 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2725 yes | yes | yes | no
2726 Arguments :
2727 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2728 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2729 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2730 closes.
2731
2732 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2733 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2734 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2735 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2736 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2737 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2738 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2739 properly tuned.
2740
2741 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2742 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2743 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2744
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002745 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2746
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002747 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2748
2749
2750mode { tcp|http|health }
2751 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2753 yes | yes | yes | yes
2754 Arguments :
2755 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2756 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2757 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2758 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2759
2760 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2761 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2762 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2763 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2764 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2765
2766 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002767 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
2768 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
2769 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
2770 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
2771 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
2772 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
2773 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002774
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002775 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2776 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2777 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002778
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002779 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002780 defaults http_instances
2781 mode http
2782
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002783 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002784
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002785
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002786monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002787 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2789 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002790 Arguments :
2791 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2792 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002793 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002794 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2795 backend and its backup.
2796
2797 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2798 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2799 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2800 servers in a list of backends.
2801
2802 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2803 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2804 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2805 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2806 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2807 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2808 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002809 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2810 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002811
2812 Example:
2813 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002814 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002815 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2816 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2817 monitor-uri /site_alive
2818 monitor fail if site_dead
2819
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002820 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002821
2822
2823monitor-net <source>
2824 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2826 yes | yes | yes | no
2827 Arguments :
2828 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2829 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2830 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2831 followed by a mask.
2832
2833 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2834 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002835 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002836 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2837
2838 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2839 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2840 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2841 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002842 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
2843 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
2844 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002845
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002846 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
2847 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
2848 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
2849 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
2850 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
2851 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002852
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002853 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2854 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002855
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002856 Example :
2857 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2858 frontend www
2859 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2860
2861 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2862
2863
2864monitor-uri <uri>
2865 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2867 yes | yes | yes | no
2868 Arguments :
2869 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2870 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2871
2872 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2873 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2874 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2875 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2876 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2877 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2878 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2879 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2880
2881 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2882 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2883 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2884 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2885 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2886 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2887
2888 Example :
2889 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2890 frontend www
2891 mode http
2892 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2893
2894 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2895
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002896
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002897option abortonclose
2898no option abortonclose
2899 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2901 yes | no | yes | yes
2902 Arguments : none
2903
2904 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2905 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2906 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2907 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002908 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002909 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2910 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2911 encountered while delivering the response.
2912
2913 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2914 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2915 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2916 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2917 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2918 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002919 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002920 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002921 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002922 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2923 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2924 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2925
2926 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2927 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2928 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2929 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2930 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2931 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2932 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2933 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002934 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002935
2936 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2937 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2938
2939 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2940
2941
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002942option accept-invalid-http-request
2943no option accept-invalid-http-request
2944 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2946 yes | yes | yes | no
2947 Arguments : none
2948
2949 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2950 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2951 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2952 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2953 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2954 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2955 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2956 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002957 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2958 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2959 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2960 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2961 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2962 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002963
2964 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2965 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2966 been confirmed.
2967
2968 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2969 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002970 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2971 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002972 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2973
2974 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2975 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2976
2977 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2978 stats socket.
2979
2980
2981option accept-invalid-http-response
2982no option accept-invalid-http-response
2983 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2985 yes | no | yes | yes
2986 Arguments : none
2987
2988 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2989 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2990 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2991 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2992 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2993 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2994 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2995 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2996 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2997
2998 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2999 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3000 been confirmed.
3001
3002 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3003 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3004 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3005 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3006
3007 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3008 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3009
3010 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3011 stats socket.
3012
3013
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003014option allbackups
3015no option allbackups
3016 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3018 yes | no | yes | yes
3019 Arguments : none
3020
3021 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3022 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3023 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3024 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3025 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3026 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3027 order between the backup servers anymore.
3028
3029 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3030 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3031
3032 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3033 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3034
3035
3036option checkcache
3037no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003038 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3040 yes | no | yes | yes
3041 Arguments : none
3042
3043 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3044 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003045 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003046 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3047 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003048 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003049
3050 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003051 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003052 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003053 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3054 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003055 to the client are :
3056 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003057 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003058 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003059 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3060 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3061 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3062 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3063 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3064 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3065 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3066 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3067 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3068 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3069 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3070
3071 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003072 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003073 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003074 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003075 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3076
3077 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3078 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003079 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003080 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3081
3082 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3083 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3084
3085
3086option clitcpka
3087no option clitcpka
3088 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3090 yes | yes | yes | no
3091 Arguments : none
3092
3093 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3094 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3095 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3096 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3097
3098 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3099 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3100 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3101 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3102
3103 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3104 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3105 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3106 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3107 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3108
3109 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3110
3111 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3112 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3113 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3114
3115 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3116 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3117
3118 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3119
3120
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003121option contstats
3122 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3124 yes | yes | yes | no
3125 Arguments : none
3126
3127 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3128 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3129 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3130 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3131 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3132 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3133 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3134
3135
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003136option dontlog-normal
3137no option dontlog-normal
3138 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3140 yes | yes | yes | no
3141 Arguments : none
3142
3143 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3144 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3145 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3146 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3147 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3148 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3149 logged.
3150
3151 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3152 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3153 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003155 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003156 logging.
3157
3158
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003159option dontlognull
3160no option dontlognull
3161 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3163 yes | yes | yes | no
3164 Arguments : none
3165
3166 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3167 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3168 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3169 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3170 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3171 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3172 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3173
3174 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3175 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3176 would not be logged.
3177
3178 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3179 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003181 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003182
3183
3184option forceclose
3185no option forceclose
3186 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003188 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003189 Arguments : none
3190
3191 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3192 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3193 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3194 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3195 global session times in the logs.
3196
3197 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003198 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003199 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3200 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3201 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3202 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003203
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003204 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3205 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3206 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3207
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003208 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3209 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3210
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003211 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003212
3213
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003214option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003215 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3217 yes | yes | yes | yes
3218 Arguments :
3219 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3220 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003221 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003222 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003223
3224 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3225 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3226 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3227 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3228 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3229 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3230 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003231 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3232 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3233 possible that the client has already brought one.
3234
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003235 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003236 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003237 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3238 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003239 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3240 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003241
3242 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3243 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3244 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3245 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3246 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3247 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3248 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3249
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003250 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3251 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3252 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3253 are under the control of the end-user.
3254
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003255 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003256 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3257 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003258 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3259 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3260 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003261
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003262 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3263 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3264 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3265 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3266 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003267
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003268 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003269 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3270 frontend www
3271 mode http
3272 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3273
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003274 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3275 backend www
3276 mode http
3277 option forwardfor header X-Client
3278
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003279 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3280 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003281
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003282
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003283option http-no-delay
3284no option http-no-delay
3285 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3287 yes | yes | yes | yes
3288 Arguments : none
3289
3290 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3291 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3292 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3293 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3294 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3295 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3296 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3297 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3298 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3299 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3300 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3301 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3302 affected.
3303
3304 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3305 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3306 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3307 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3308 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3309 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3310 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3311 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3312 latency environments.
3313
3314
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003315option http-pretend-keepalive
3316no option http-pretend-keepalive
3317 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3319 yes | yes | yes | yes
3320 Arguments : none
3321
3322 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3323 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3324 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3325 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3326 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3327 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3328 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3329 consider the response complete.
3330
3331 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3332 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3333 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3334 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3335 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3336 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3337
3338 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3339 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3340 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3341 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3342 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3343 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3344 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3345
3346 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3347 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003348 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003349 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3350 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003351
3352 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3353 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3354
3355 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3356
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003357
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003358option http-server-close
3359no option http-server-close
3360 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3362 yes | yes | yes | yes
3363 Arguments : none
3364
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003365 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3366 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3367 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3368 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3369 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3370 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3371 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3372 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3373 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3374 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3375 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3376 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003377
3378 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3379 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3380 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3381 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003382 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3383 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003384
3385 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3386 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003387 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3388 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3389 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003390
3391 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3392 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3393
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003394 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3395 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003396
3397
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003398option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003399no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003400 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3402 yes | yes | yes | no
3403 Arguments : none
3404
3405 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3406 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3407 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3408 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3409 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3410 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3411 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3412
3413 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3414 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3415 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3416 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3417 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3418 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3419 request along its whole life.
3420
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003421 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3422 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3423 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3424 front of an existing proxy.
3425
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003426 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3427
3428 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3429 http-server-close".
3430
3431
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003432option httpchk
3433option httpchk <uri>
3434option httpchk <method> <uri>
3435option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3436 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3438 yes | no | yes | yes
3439 Arguments :
3440 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3441 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3442 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3443 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3444 ones.
3445
3446 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3447 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3448 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3449
3450 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3451 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3452 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3453 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3454 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3455
3456 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3457 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3458 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3459 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3460 the lack of any response.
3461
3462 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3463
3464 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3465 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3466 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3467
3468 Examples :
3469 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3470 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3471 backend https_relay
3472 mode tcp
3473 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3474 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3475
3476 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003477 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3478 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003479
3480
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003481option httpclose
3482no option httpclose
3483 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3485 yes | yes | yes | yes
3486 Arguments : none
3487
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003488 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3489 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3490 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3491 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3492 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3493 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3494 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003495
3496 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003497 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003498 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3499 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3500 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3501 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3502 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003503
3504 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3505 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3506 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003507 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3508 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003509
3510 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3511 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3512
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003513 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3514 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003515
3516
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003517option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003518 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3520 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003521 Arguments :
3522 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3523 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3524 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3525 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3526 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003527
3528 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3529 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3530 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3531 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3532 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3533 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3534 ports.
3535
3536 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3537
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003538 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3539 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3540 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3541 by default.
3542
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003543 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003544
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003545
3546option http_proxy
3547no option http_proxy
3548 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3550 yes | yes | yes | yes
3551 Arguments : none
3552
3553 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3554 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3555 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3556 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3557 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3558
3559 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3560 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3561 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3562 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003563 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003564 be analyzed.
3565
3566 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3567 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3568
3569 Example :
3570 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3571 backend direct_forward
3572 option httpclose
3573 option http_proxy
3574
3575 See also : "option httpclose"
3576
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003577
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003578option independent-streams
3579no option independent-streams
3580 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3582 yes | yes | yes | yes
3583 Arguments : none
3584
3585 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3586 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3587 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3588 receive data or not.
3589
3590 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3591 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3592 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3593 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3594 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3595 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3596 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3597 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3598 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3599 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3600 socket buffers.
3601
3602 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3603 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3604 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3605 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3606 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3607
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003608 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3609 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3610 deprecated.
3611
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003612 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003613
3614
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003615option ldap-check
3616 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3618 yes | no | yes | yes
3619 Arguments : none
3620
3621 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3622 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3623 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3624 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3625
3626 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3627 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3628
3629 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3630 configure it.
3631
3632 Example :
3633 option ldap-check
3634
3635 See also : "option httpchk"
3636
3637
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003638option log-health-checks
3639no option log-health-checks
3640 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3642 yes | no | yes | yes
3643 Arguments : none
3644
3645 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3646 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3647 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3648 of additional information is limited.
3649
3650 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3651 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3652
3653 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3654
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003655
3656option log-separate-errors
3657no option log-separate-errors
3658 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3660 yes | yes | yes | no
3661 Arguments : none
3662
3663 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3664 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3665 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3666 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3667 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3668 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3669 provides very important information.
3670
3671 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3672 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3673 error logs.
3674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003675 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003676 logging.
3677
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003678
3679option logasap
3680no option logasap
3681 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3683 yes | yes | yes | no
3684 Arguments : none
3685
3686 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3687 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3688 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3689 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3690 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3691 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3692 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003693 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003694 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3695 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3696
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003697 Examples :
3698 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3699 mode http
3700 option httplog
3701 option logasap
3702 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3703
3704 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3705 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3706 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3707 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003709 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003710 logging.
3711
3712
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003713option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3714 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3716 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003717 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003718 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3719 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003720
3721 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3722 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3723 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3724 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3725 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3726 in the MySQL table, like this :
3727
3728 USE mysql;
3729 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3730 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3731
3732 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3733 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3734 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3735 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3736 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3737 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3738 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3739 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3740 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3741
3742 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3743 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003744
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003745 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003746
3747 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3748 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3749 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3750 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3751 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3752 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3753
3754 See also: "option httpchk"
3755
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003756option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3757 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3759 yes | no | yes | yes
3760 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003761 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3762 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003763
3764 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3765 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3766 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3767 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3768
3769 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003770
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003771option nolinger
3772no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003773 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003774 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3775 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003776 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003777
3778 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3779 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3780 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3781 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3782 connections.
3783
3784 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3785 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3786 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3787 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3788 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3789 this too.
3790
3791 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3792 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3793 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3794
3795 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3796 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3797 for servers.
3798
3799 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3800 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3801
3802
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003803option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3804 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3806 yes | yes | yes | yes
3807 Arguments :
3808 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3809 matching <network>
3810 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3811 header name.
3812
3813 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3814 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3815 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3816 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3817 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3818 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3819 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3820 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3821 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3822 possible that the client has already brought one.
3823
3824 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3825 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3826 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3827 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3828 header and requires different one.
3829
3830 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3831 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3832 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3833 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3834 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3835 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3836 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3837
3838 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3839 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3840 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3841 both are defined.
3842
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003843 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3844 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3845 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3846 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3847 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003848
3849 Examples :
3850 # Original Destination address
3851 frontend www
3852 mode http
3853 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3854
3855 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3856 backend www
3857 mode http
3858 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3859
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003860 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3861 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003862
3863
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003864option persist
3865no option persist
3866 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3867 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3868 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003869 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003870
3871 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3872 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3873 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3874 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3875 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3876 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3877 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3878 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3879 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3880 redirected to another valid server.
3881
3882 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3883 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3884
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003885 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003886
3887
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003888option redispatch
3889no option redispatch
3890 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3891 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3892 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003893 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003894
3895 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3896 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3897 be able to access the service anymore.
3898
3899 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3900 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3901
3902 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3903 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3904 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003905
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003906 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3907 "redisp" keywords.
3908
3909 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3910 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3911
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003912 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003913
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003914
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003915option redis-check
3916 Use redis health checks for server testing
3917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3918 yes | no | yes | yes
3919 Arguments : none
3920
3921 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3922 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3923 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3924 find the "+PONG" response message.
3925
3926 Example :
3927 option redis-check
3928
3929 See also : "option httpchk"
3930
3931
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003932option smtpchk
3933option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3934 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3936 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003937 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003938 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3939 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3940 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3941
3942 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3943 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3944 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3945
3946 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3947 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3948 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3949 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3950 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3951 dead server.
3952
3953 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3954 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3955 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3956 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3957
3958 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3959 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3960 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3961 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3962 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3963
3964 Example :
3965 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3966
3967 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3968
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003969
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003970option socket-stats
3971no option socket-stats
3972
3973 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3975 yes | yes | yes | no
3976
3977 Arguments : none
3978
3979
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003980option splice-auto
3981no option splice-auto
3982 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3984 yes | yes | yes | yes
3985 Arguments : none
3986
3987 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3988 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3989 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3990 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003991 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003992 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3993 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3994 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3995 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3996
3997 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3998 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3999 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4000 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4001 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4002 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4003 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4004 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4005 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4006 keyword.
4007
4008 Example :
4009 option splice-auto
4010
4011 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4012 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4013
4014 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4015 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4016
4017
4018option splice-request
4019no option splice-request
4020 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4022 yes | yes | yes | yes
4023 Arguments : none
4024
4025 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004026 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004027 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4028 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4029 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4030 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4031
4032 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4033
4034 Example :
4035 option splice-request
4036
4037 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4038 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4039
4040 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4041 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4042
4043
4044option splice-response
4045no option splice-response
4046 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4048 yes | yes | yes | yes
4049 Arguments : none
4050
4051 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004052 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004053 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4054 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4055 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4056 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4057
4058 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4059
4060 Example :
4061 option splice-response
4062
4063 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4064 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4065
4066 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4067 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4068
4069
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004070option srvtcpka
4071no option srvtcpka
4072 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4074 yes | no | yes | yes
4075 Arguments : none
4076
4077 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4078 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4079 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4080 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4081
4082 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4083 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4084 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4085 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4086
4087 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4088 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4089 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4090 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4091 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4092
4093 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4094
4095 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4096 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4097 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4098
4099 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4100 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4101
4102 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4103
4104
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004105option ssl-hello-chk
4106 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4108 yes | no | yes | yes
4109 Arguments : none
4110
4111 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4112 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4113 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4114 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4115 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4116 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4117 hello message.
4118
4119 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4120 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4121 messages, which is appreciable.
4122
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004123 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4124 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4125 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004126
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004127 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4128
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004129
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004130option tcp-smart-accept
4131no option tcp-smart-accept
4132 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4134 yes | yes | yes | no
4135 Arguments : none
4136
4137 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4138 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4139 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4140 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4141 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4142 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4143
4144 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4145 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4146 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4147 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4148
4149 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4150 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4151 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4152 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4153
4154 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4155 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4156 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4157
4158 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4159 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4160 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4161
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004162 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4163
4164
4165option tcp-smart-connect
4166no option tcp-smart-connect
4167 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4169 yes | no | yes | yes
4170 Arguments : none
4171
4172 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4173 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4174 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4175 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4176 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4177
4178 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4179 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4180 complex.
4181
4182 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4183 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4184 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4185
4186 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4187 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4188
4189 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4190
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004191
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004192option tcpka
4193 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4195 yes | yes | yes | yes
4196 Arguments : none
4197
4198 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4199 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4200 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4201 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4202
4203 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4204 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4205 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4206 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4207
4208 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4209 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4210 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4211 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4212 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4213
4214 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4215
4216 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4217 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4218 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4219 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4220 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4221 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4222 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4223 backends.
4224
4225 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4226
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004227
4228option tcplog
4229 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4231 yes | yes | yes | yes
4232 Arguments : none
4233
4234 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4235 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4236 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4237 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4238 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4239 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4240 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4241 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4242
4243 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004245 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004246
4247
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004248option transparent
4249no option transparent
4250 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004252 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004253 Arguments : none
4254
4255 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4256 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4257 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4258 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4259 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4260 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4261 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4262 appropriate server.
4263
4264 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4265 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4266
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004267 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004268 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004269
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004270
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004271persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004272persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004273 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4275 yes | no | yes | yes
4276 Arguments :
4277 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004278 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4279 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004280
4281 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4282 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4283 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4284 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4285 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4286 forwarded to this server.
4287
4288 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4289 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4290 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004291 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004292 a single "listen" section.
4293
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004294 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4295 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4296 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4297
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004298 Example :
4299 listen tse-farm
4300 bind :3389
4301 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4302 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4303 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4304 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4305 persist rdp-cookie
4306 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004307 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004308 balance rdp-cookie
4309 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4310 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4311
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004312 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4313 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004314
4315
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004316rate-limit sessions <rate>
4317 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4319 yes | yes | yes | no
4320 Arguments :
4321 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4322 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4323
4324 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4325 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4326 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4327 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4328 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4329 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4330
4331 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4332 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4333 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4334 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4335
4336 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4337 listen smtp
4338 mode tcp
4339 bind :25
4340 rate-limit sessions 10
4341 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4342
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004343 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4344 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4345 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004346
4347 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4348
4349
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004350redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4351redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4352redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004353 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4355 no | yes | yes | yes
4356
4357 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004358 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004359
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004360 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004361 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4362 the HTTP "Location" header.
4363
4364 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4365 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4366 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4367 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4368 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4369 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4370
4371 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4372 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4373 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4374 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4375 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4376 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4377 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4378 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4379 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004380
4381 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4382 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4383 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4384 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4385 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4386 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4387 location with a GET method.
4388
4389 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4390 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4391
4392 - "drop-query"
4393 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4394 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4395 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4396 with a location-type redirect.
4397
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004398 - "append-slash"
4399 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4400 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4401 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4402 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4403
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004404 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4405 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4406 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4407 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4408 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4409 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4410 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4411
4412 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4413 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4414 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4415 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4416 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4417 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4418 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004419
4420 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4421 acl clear dst_port 80
4422 acl secure dst_port 8080
4423 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004424 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004425 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004426 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4427
4428 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004429 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4430 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4431 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004432 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004433
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004434 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4435 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4436 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4437
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004438 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004439 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004440
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004441 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004442
4443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004444redisp (deprecated)
4445redispatch (deprecated)
4446 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4447 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4448 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004449 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004450
4451 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4452 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4453 be able to access the service anymore.
4454
4455 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4456 redistribute them to a working server.
4457
4458 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4459 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4460 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004461
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004462 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4463 "option redispatch" instead.
4464
4465 See also : "option redispatch"
4466
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004467
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004468reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004469 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4471 no | yes | yes | yes
4472 Arguments :
4473 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4474 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004475 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004476
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004477 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4478 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4479
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004480 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4481 the last header of an HTTP request.
4482
4483 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4484 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4485 responses.
4486
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004487 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4488 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4489 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4490
4491 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4492 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004493
4494
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004495reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4496reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004497 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4499 no | yes | yes | yes
4500 Arguments :
4501 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4502 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4503 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4504 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4505 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4506 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4507 ignores case.
4508
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004509 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4510 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4511
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004512 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4513 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4514 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4515 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004516 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004517
4518 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4519 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4520
4521 Example :
4522 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4523 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4524 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4525
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004526 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4527 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004528
4529
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004530reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4531reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004532 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4534 no | yes | yes | yes
4535 Arguments :
4536 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4537 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4538 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4539 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4540 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4541 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4542
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004543 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4544 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4545
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004546 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4547 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4548 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4549 next servers.
4550
4551 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4552 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4553 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4554
4555 Example :
4556 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4557 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4558 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4559
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004560 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4561 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004562
4563
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004564reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4565reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004566 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4568 no | yes | yes | yes
4569 Arguments :
4570 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4571 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4572 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4573 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4574 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4575 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4576 case.
4577
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004578 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4579 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4580
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004581 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4582 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4583 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4584 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004585 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004586
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004587 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004588 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004589 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004590
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004591 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4592 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4593
4594 Example :
4595 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4596 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4597 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4598
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004599 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4600 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004601
4602
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004603reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4604reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004605 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4607 no | yes | yes | yes
4608 Arguments :
4609 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4610 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4611 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4612 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4613 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4614 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4615 case.
4616
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004617 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4618 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4619
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004620 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4621 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4622 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4623 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4624
4625 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4626 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4627
4628 Example :
4629 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4630 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4631 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4632 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4633
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004634 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4635 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004636
4637
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004638reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4639reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004640 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4642 no | yes | yes | yes
4643 Arguments :
4644 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4645 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4646 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4647 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4648 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4649 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4650
4651 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4652 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4653 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4654 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004655 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004656
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004657 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4658 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4659
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004660 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4661 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4662 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4663
4664 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4665 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4666 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4667 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4668 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4669
4670 Example :
4671 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004672 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004673 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4674 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4675
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04004676 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
4677 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004678
4679
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004680reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4681reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004682 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4684 no | yes | yes | yes
4685 Arguments :
4686 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4687 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4688 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4689 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4690 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4691 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4692 ignores case.
4693
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004694 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4695 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4696
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004697 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4698 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004699 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4700 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4701 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004702 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4703 not set.
4704
4705 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4706 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4707 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4708 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4709 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4710
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004711 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004712 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4713 # block all others.
4714 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4715 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4716
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004717 # block bad guys
4718 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4719 reqitarpit . if badguys
4720
4721 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4722 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004723
4724
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004725retries <value>
4726 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4727 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4728 yes | no | yes | yes
4729 Arguments :
4730 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4731 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4732 default value is 3.
4733
4734 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4735 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4736 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4737
4738 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4739 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4740
4741 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4742 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4743
4744 See also : "option redispatch"
4745
4746
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004747rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004748 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4750 no | yes | yes | yes
4751 Arguments :
4752 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4753 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004754 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004755
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004756 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4757 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4758
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004759 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4760 the last header of an HTTP response.
4761
4762 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4763 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4764 responses.
4765
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004766 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4767 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004768
4769
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004770rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4771rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004772 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4774 no | yes | yes | yes
4775 Arguments :
4776 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4777 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4778 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4779 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4780 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4781 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4782 ignores case.
4783
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004784 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4785 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4786
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004787 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4788 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004789 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004790 client.
4791
4792 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4793 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4794 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4795
4796 Example :
4797 # remove the Server header from responses
4798 reqidel ^Server:.*
4799
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004800 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4801 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004802
4803
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004804rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4805rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004806 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4808 no | yes | yes | yes
4809 Arguments :
4810 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4811 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4812 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4813 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4814 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4815 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4816 ignores case.
4817
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004818 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4819 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4820
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004821 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4822 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4823 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4824 case-sensitive.
4825
4826 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004827 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4828 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4829 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004830
4831 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4832 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4833
4834 Example :
4835 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4836 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4837
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004838 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4839 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004840
4841
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004842rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4843rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004844 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4846 no | yes | yes | yes
4847 Arguments :
4848 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4849 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4850 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4851 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4852 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4853 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4854 ignores case.
4855
4856 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4857 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4858 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4859 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004860 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004861
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004862 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4863 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4864
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004865 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4866 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4867 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4868
4869 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4870 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4871 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4872 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4873 are not case-sensitive.
4874
4875 Example :
4876 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4877 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4878
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004879 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4880 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004881
4882
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004883server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004884 Declare a server in a backend
4885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4886 no | no | yes | yes
4887 Arguments :
4888 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02004889 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004890 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004891
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004892 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4893 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4894 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4895 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004896 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4897 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4898 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4899 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4900 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4901 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004902
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004903 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004904 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4905 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4906 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4907 adding this value to the client's port.
4908
4909 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4910 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004911 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004912
4913 Examples :
4914 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4915 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4916
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004917 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4918 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004919
4920
4921source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004922source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004923source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004924 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4926 yes | no | yes | yes
4927 Arguments :
4928 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4929 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4930 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4931 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4932
4933 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4934 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004935 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4936 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4937 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004938
4939 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4940 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4941 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4942 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4943 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4944 <addr>.
4945
4946 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4947 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4948 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4949 port.
4950
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004951 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4952 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4953 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4954 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4955 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4956 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4957 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4958 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4959 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4960 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4961 HTTP header.
4962
4963 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4964 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004965 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004966 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4967 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4968 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4969 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4970 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4971 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4972 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4973
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004974 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4975 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4976 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4977 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4978 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4979 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4980
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004981 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4982 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4983 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4984 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4985
4986 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4987 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4988 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4989 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4990 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4991 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4992
4993 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4994 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4995 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4996 there are two methods :
4997
4998 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4999 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5000 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5001 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5002 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5003 of the client ranges may be used.
5004
5005 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5006 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5007 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5008 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5009 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5010 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5011 same session.
5012
5013 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5014 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5015 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5016 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5017 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5018 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5019
5020 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5021 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5022 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005023 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005024
5025 Examples :
5026 backend private
5027 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5028 source 192.168.1.200
5029
5030 backend transparent_ssl1
5031 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5032 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5033
5034 backend transparent_ssl2
5035 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5036 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5037 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5038
5039 backend transparent_ssl3
5040 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5041 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5042 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5043
5044 backend transparent_smtp
5045 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5046 # with Tproxy version 4.
5047 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5048
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005049 backend transparent_http
5050 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5051 # proxy.
5052 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5053
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005054 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005055 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005057
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005058srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5059 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5061 yes | no | yes | yes
5062 Arguments :
5063 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5064 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5065 as explained at the top of this document.
5066
5067 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5068 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5069 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5070 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5071 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5072 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5073 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5074
5075 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5076 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5077 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5078 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5079 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005080 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005081 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005082 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005083
5084 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5085 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5086 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5087 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5088 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5089 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5090
5091 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5092 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5093
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005094 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5095 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005096
5097
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005098stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5099 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5101 no | no | yes | yes
5102
5103 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5104 matched.
5105
5106 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5107 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5108
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005109 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5110 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5111 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5112
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005113 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5114 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5115 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5116 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005117
5118 Example :
5119 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5120 backend stats_localhost
5121 stats enable
5122 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5123
5124 Example :
5125 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5126 backend stats_auth
5127 stats enable
5128 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5129 stats admin if TRUE
5130
5131 Example :
5132 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5133 userlist stats-auth
5134 group admin users admin
5135 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5136 group readonly users haproxy
5137 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5138
5139 backend stats_auth
5140 stats enable
5141 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5142 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5143 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5144 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5145
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005146 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5147 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5148 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005149
5150
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005151stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5152 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5154 yes | no | yes | yes
5155 Arguments :
5156 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5157
5158 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5159
5160 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5161 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5162 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5163 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5164 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5165 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5166
5167 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5168 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5169 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005170 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005171
5172 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5173 report using "stats scope".
5174
5175 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5176 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5177 unobvious parameters.
5178
5179 Example :
5180 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5181 backend public_www
5182 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5183 stats enable
5184 stats hide-version
5185 stats scope .
5186 stats uri /admin?stats
5187 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5188 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5189 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5190
5191 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5192 backend private_monitoring
5193 stats enable
5194 stats uri /admin?stats
5195 stats refresh 5s
5196
5197 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5198
5199
5200stats enable
5201 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5203 yes | no | yes | yes
5204 Arguments : none
5205
5206 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5207 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5208 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5209 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5210 - stats auth : no authentication
5211 - stats scope : no restriction
5212
5213 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5214 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5215 unobvious parameters.
5216
5217 Example :
5218 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5219 backend public_www
5220 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5221 stats enable
5222 stats hide-version
5223 stats scope .
5224 stats uri /admin?stats
5225 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5226 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5227 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5228
5229 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5230 backend private_monitoring
5231 stats enable
5232 stats uri /admin?stats
5233 stats refresh 5s
5234
5235 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5236
5237
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005238stats hide-version
5239 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5241 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005242 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005243
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005244 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5245 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5246 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5247 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5248 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5249 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005250
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005251 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5252 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5253 unobvious parameters.
5254
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005255 Example :
5256 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5257 backend public_www
5258 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005259 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005260 stats hide-version
5261 stats scope .
5262 stats uri /admin?stats
5263 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5264 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5265 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005266
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005267 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5268 backend private_monitoring
5269 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005270 stats uri /admin?stats
5271 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005272
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005273 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005274
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005275
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005276stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5277 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5278 Access control for statistics
5279
5280 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5281 no | no | yes | yes
5282
5283 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5284 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5285 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5286 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5287 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5288 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5289
5290 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5291 instance.
5292
5293 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5294 about ACL usage.
5295
5296
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005297stats realm <realm>
5298 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5300 yes | no | yes | yes
5301 Arguments :
5302 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5303 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5304 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5305
5306 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5307 using a backslash ('\').
5308
5309 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5310 only related to authentication.
5311
5312 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5313 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5314 unobvious parameters.
5315
5316 Example :
5317 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5318 backend public_www
5319 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5320 stats enable
5321 stats hide-version
5322 stats scope .
5323 stats uri /admin?stats
5324 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5325 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5326 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5327
5328 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5329 backend private_monitoring
5330 stats enable
5331 stats uri /admin?stats
5332 stats refresh 5s
5333
5334 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5335
5336
5337stats refresh <delay>
5338 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5340 yes | no | yes | yes
5341 Arguments :
5342 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5343 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5344 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5345 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5346 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5347 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5348
5349 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5350 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5351 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5352 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5353
5354 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5355 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5356 unobvious parameters.
5357
5358 Example :
5359 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5360 backend public_www
5361 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5362 stats enable
5363 stats hide-version
5364 stats scope .
5365 stats uri /admin?stats
5366 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5367 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5368 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5369
5370 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5371 backend private_monitoring
5372 stats enable
5373 stats uri /admin?stats
5374 stats refresh 5s
5375
5376 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5377
5378
5379stats scope { <name> | "." }
5380 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5382 yes | no | yes | yes
5383 Arguments :
5384 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5385 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5386 section in which the statement appears.
5387
5388 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5389 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5390 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5391 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5392 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5393 exists.
5394
5395 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5396 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5397 unobvious parameters.
5398
5399 Example :
5400 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5401 backend public_www
5402 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5403 stats enable
5404 stats hide-version
5405 stats scope .
5406 stats uri /admin?stats
5407 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5408 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5409 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5410
5411 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5412 backend private_monitoring
5413 stats enable
5414 stats uri /admin?stats
5415 stats refresh 5s
5416
5417 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5418
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005419
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005420stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005421 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5423 yes | no | yes | yes
5424
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005425 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005426 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5427
5428 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5429 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5430
5431 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5432 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005433 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005434
5435 Example :
5436 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5437 backend private_monitoring
5438 stats enable
5439 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5440 stats uri /admin?stats
5441 stats refresh 5s
5442
5443 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5444 global section.
5445
5446
5447stats show-legends
5448 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5449 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5450 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5451 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5452 - IP (socket, server)
5453 - cookie (backend, server)
5454
5455 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5456 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005457 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005458
5459 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5460
5461
5462stats show-node [ <name> ]
5463 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5465 yes | no | yes | yes
5466 Arguments:
5467 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5468 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5469
5470 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5471 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005472 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005473
5474 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5475 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5476 unobvious parameters.
5477
5478 Example:
5479 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5480 backend private_monitoring
5481 stats enable
5482 stats show-node Europe-1
5483 stats uri /admin?stats
5484 stats refresh 5s
5485
5486 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5487 section.
5488
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005489
5490stats uri <prefix>
5491 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5493 yes | no | yes | yes
5494 Arguments :
5495 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5496 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5497 query string.
5498
5499 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5500 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5501 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5502 possible to reach it in the application.
5503
5504 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005505 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005506 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5507 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5508 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5509 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5510
5511 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5512 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5513 an address or a port to statistics only.
5514
5515 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5516 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5517 unobvious parameters.
5518
5519 Example :
5520 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5521 backend public_www
5522 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5523 stats enable
5524 stats hide-version
5525 stats scope .
5526 stats uri /admin?stats
5527 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5528 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5529 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5530
5531 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5532 backend private_monitoring
5533 stats enable
5534 stats uri /admin?stats
5535 stats refresh 5s
5536
5537 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5538
5539
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005540stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5541 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005543 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005544
5545 Arguments :
5546 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5547 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5548 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5549 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5550
5551 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5552 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5553 the "stick-table" statement.
5554
5555 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5556 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5557 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5558 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5559 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5560
5561 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5562 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5563 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5564 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5565 transformation rules.
5566
5567 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5568 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5569 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5570 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5571 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5572 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5573 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5574
5575 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5576 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5577 ACL based conditions.
5578
5579 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5580 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5581 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5582 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5583
5584 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5585 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5586 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5587 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5588
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005589 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5590 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5591 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5592
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005593 Example :
5594 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5595 # last 30 minutes
5596 backend pop
5597 mode tcp
5598 balance roundrobin
5599 stick store-request src
5600 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5601 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5602 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5603
5604 backend smtp
5605 mode tcp
5606 balance roundrobin
5607 stick match src table pop
5608 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5609 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5610
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005611 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5612 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005613
5614
5615stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5616 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5618 no | no | yes | yes
5619
5620 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5621 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5622 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5623 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5624
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005625 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5626 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5627 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5628
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005629 Examples :
5630 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005631 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005632
5633 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5634 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5635 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5636
5637
5638 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5639 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5640 backend http
5641 mode http
5642 balance roundrobin
5643 stick on src table https
5644 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5645 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5646 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5647
5648 backend https
5649 mode tcp
5650 balance roundrobin
5651 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5652 stick on src
5653 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5654 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5655
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005656 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005657
5658
5659stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5660 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5662 no | no | yes | yes
5663
5664 Arguments :
5665 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5666 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5667 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5668 server is selected.
5669
5670 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5671 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5672 the "stick-table" statement.
5673
5674 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5675 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5676 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5677 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5678 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5679 address.
5680
5681 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5682 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5683 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5684 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5685 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5686 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5687 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5688 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5689 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5690 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5691
5692 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5693 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5694 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5695 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5696 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5697 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5698 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5699
5700 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5701 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5702 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5703 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5704
5705 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5706 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5707 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5708 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5709 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5710 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5711 another protocol or access method.
5712
5713 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5714 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5715 the request.
5716
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005717 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5718 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5719 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5720
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005721 Example :
5722 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5723 # last 30 minutes
5724 backend pop
5725 mode tcp
5726 balance roundrobin
5727 stick store-request src
5728 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5729 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5730 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5731
5732 backend smtp
5733 mode tcp
5734 balance roundrobin
5735 stick match src table pop
5736 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5737 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5738
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005739 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5740 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005741
5742
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005743stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005744 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5745 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005746 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005748 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005749
5750 Arguments :
5751 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5752 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5753 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5754 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5755
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005756 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5757 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5758 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5759 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5760
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005761 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5762 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5763 instance.
5764
5765 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5766 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5767 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5768 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5769 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5770 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005771 to 32 characters.
5772
5773 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5774 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5775 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5776 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5777 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5778 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005779
5780 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005781 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5782 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005783 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5784 increase.
5785
5786 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005787 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5788 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5789 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005790
5791 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5792 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5793 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5794 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5795 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5796 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5797 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5798 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5799 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5800 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5801 parameter (see below).
5802
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005803 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5804 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5805 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5806 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5807 soft restart.
5808
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005809 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5810
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005811 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5812 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5813 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5814 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5815 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005816 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005817 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5818 if not expiration delay is specified.
5819
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005820 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5821 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5822 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5823 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005824 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5825 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5826 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5827 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5828 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5829 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5830 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5831 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5832 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5833 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5834 types and their arguments.
5835
5836 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5837 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5838 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5839 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5840
5841 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5842 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5843 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5844 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5845
5846 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5847 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5848 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5849 they were received.
5850
5851 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5852 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5853 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5854 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5855 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5856
5857 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5858 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5859 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5860 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5861 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5862
5863 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5864 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5865 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5866
5867 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5868 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5869 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5870 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5871 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5872
5873 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5874 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5875 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5876 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5877 the client side.
5878
5879 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5880 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5881 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5882 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5883 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5884 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5885 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5886
5887 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5888 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5889 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5890 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5891 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5892 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5893 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5894
5895 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5896 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5897 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5898 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5899 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5900 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5901
5902 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5903 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5904 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5905 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5906
5907 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5908 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5909 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5910 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5911 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5912 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5913 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5914 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5915 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5916 recommended for better fairness.
5917
5918 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5919 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5920 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5921 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5922
5923 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5924 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5925 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5926 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5927 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5928 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5929 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5930 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5931 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5932 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005933
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005934 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5935 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005936 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5937 reference it.
5938
5939 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5940 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5941 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5942 as an exclusive stickiness.
5943
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005944 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5945 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5946 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5947 something that can be ignored.
5948
5949 Example:
5950 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5951 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5952 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5953 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5954
5955 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005956 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005957
5958
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005959stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5960 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5962 no | no | yes | yes
5963
5964 Arguments :
5965 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5966 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5967 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5968 server is selected.
5969
5970 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5971 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5972 the "stick-table" statement.
5973
5974 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5975 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5976 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5977 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5978
5979 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5980 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5981 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5982 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5983 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5984 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005985 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005986 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5987 rules.
5988
5989 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5990 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5991 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5992 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5993 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5994 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5995 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5996
5997 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5998 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5999 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6000 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6001
6002 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6003 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6004 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6005 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6006 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6007 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6008 another protocol or access method.
6009
6010 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6011
6012 Example :
6013 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6014 backend https
6015 mode tcp
6016 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006017 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006018 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006019
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006020 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6021 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6022
6023 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6024 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6025 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6026
6027 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6028 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006029
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006030 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6031 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6032 # at offset 44.
6033
6034 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6035 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6036
6037 # Learn on response if server hello.
6038 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006039
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006040 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6041 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6042
6043 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6044 extraction.
6045
6046
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006047tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6048 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6050 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006051 Arguments :
6052 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6053 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6054 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006055
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006056 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006057
6058 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6059 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006060 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6061 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6062 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6063 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6064 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6065 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006066
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006067 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6068 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6069 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6070 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006071
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006072 Three types of actions are supported :
6073 - accept :
6074 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6075 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6076 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006077
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006078 - reject :
6079 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6080 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6081 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6082 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6083 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6084 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6085 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6086 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6087 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6088 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6089 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6090 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006091
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006092 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6093 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6094 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6095 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6096 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6097 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6098 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6099 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6100 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006101
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006102 These actions take one or two arguments :
6103 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6104 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6105 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006106
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006107 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6108 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6109 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6110 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006111
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006112 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6113 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6114 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6115 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6116 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6117 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6118 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6119 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6120 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6121 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006122
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006123 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6124 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6125 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006126
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006127 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6128 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6129 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006130
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006131 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006132 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006133 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006134
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006135 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6136 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6137 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006138
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006139 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6140 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6141 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006142
6143 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6144
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006145 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006146
6147
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006148tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6149 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006151 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006152 Arguments :
6153 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6154 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6155 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006156
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006157 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006158
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006159 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6160 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6161 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6162 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6163 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006164
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006165 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6166 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6167 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6168 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6169 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6170 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6171 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6172 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6173 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006174
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006175 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6176 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6177 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6178 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006179
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006180 Three types of actions are supported :
6181 - accept :
6182 - reject :
6183 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006184
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006185 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6186 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006187
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006188 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6189 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6190 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6191 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6192 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6193 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006194
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006195 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006196 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6197 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006198
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006199 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006200 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6201 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6202 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6203 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6204 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006205
6206 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006207 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6208 # and reject everything else.
6209 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6210 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006211 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006212 tcp-request content reject
6213
6214 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006215 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6216 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6217 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006218 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006219
6220 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6221 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6222 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006223 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006224 tcp-request content reject
6225
6226 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6227 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6228
6229 frontend http
6230 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6231 # protecting all our sites
6232 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6233 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6234 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6235 ...
6236 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6237
6238 backend http_dynamic
6239 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6240 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6241 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6242 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6243 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6244 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6245 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006246
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006247 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006248
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006249 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006250
6251
6252tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6253 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006255 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006256 Arguments :
6257 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6258 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6259 as explained at the top of this document.
6260
6261 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6262 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6263 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6264 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6265 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6266
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006267 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6268 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6269 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6270 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6271
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006272 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6273 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006274 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006275 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006276 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6277 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6278 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6279 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006280
6281 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6282 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6283 it pass through unaffected.
6284
6285 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6286 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6287 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006288 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006289 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6290 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006291 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6292 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6293 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006294
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006295 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006296 "timeout client".
6297
6298
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006299tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6300 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6302 no | no | yes | yes
6303 Arguments :
6304 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6305 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6306 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6307
6308 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6309
6310 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6311 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6312 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6313 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006314 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006315
6316 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6317
6318 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6319 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6320 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6321 inserted.
6322
6323 Two types of actions are supported :
6324 - accept :
6325 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6326 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6327 the rules evaluation.
6328
6329 - reject :
6330 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6331 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006332 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006333
6334 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6335 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6336 for changing the default action to a reject.
6337
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006338 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6339 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6340 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6341 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006342 period.
6343
6344 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6345
6346 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6347
6348
6349tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6350 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6352 no | no | yes | yes
6353 Arguments :
6354 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6355 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6356 as explained at the top of this document.
6357
6358 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6359
6360
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006361timeout check <timeout>
6362 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6363 established.
6364
6365 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6366 yes | no | yes | yes
6367 Arguments:
6368 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6369 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6370 as explained at the top of this document.
6371
6372 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6373 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6374 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6375 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006376 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6377 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6378 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006379
6380 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6381 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6382
6383 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6384 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006385 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006386
6387 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6388 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6389 forget about it.
6390
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006391 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6392 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006393
6394
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006395timeout client <timeout>
6396timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6397 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6399 yes | yes | yes | no
6400 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006401 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006402 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6403 as explained at the top of this document.
6404
6405 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6406 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6407 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6408 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6409 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6410 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6411 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6412 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006413 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006414 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006415 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6416 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6417 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006418
6419 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6420 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6421 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6422 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6423 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6424 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6425
6426 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6427 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6428 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6429
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006430 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006431
6432
6433timeout connect <timeout>
6434timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6435 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6437 yes | no | yes | yes
6438 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006439 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006440 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6441 as explained at the top of this document.
6442
6443 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006444 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006445 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006446 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006447 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6448 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006449
6450 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6451 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6452 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6453 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6454 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6455 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6456
6457 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6458 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6459 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6460
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006461 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6462 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006463
6464
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006465timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6466 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6468 yes | yes | yes | yes
6469 Arguments :
6470 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6471 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6472 as explained at the top of this document.
6473
6474 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6475 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6476 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6477 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6478 once the request has started to present itself.
6479
6480 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6481 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6482 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6483 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6484 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6485
6486 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6487 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6488 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6489 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6490
6491 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6492 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6493 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6494 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6495 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006496 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006497
6498 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6499 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6500 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6501 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6502
6503 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6504
6505
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006506timeout http-request <timeout>
6507 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006509 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006510 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006511 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006512 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6513 as explained at the top of this document.
6514
6515 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6516 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6517 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6518 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6519 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6520 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6521 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6522 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6523
6524 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6525 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006526 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6527 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006528
6529 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6530 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6531 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6532 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6533 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6534
6535 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006536 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6537 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6538 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006539
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006540 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006541
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006542
6543timeout queue <timeout>
6544 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6546 yes | no | yes | yes
6547 Arguments :
6548 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6549 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6550 as explained at the top of this document.
6551
6552 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6553 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6554 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6555 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6556 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6557
6558 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6559 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6560 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6561 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6562
6563 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6564
6565
6566timeout server <timeout>
6567timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6568 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6570 yes | no | yes | yes
6571 Arguments :
6572 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6573 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6574 as explained at the top of this document.
6575
6576 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6577 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6578 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6579 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6580 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6581 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6582 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6583
6584 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6585 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6586 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6587 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6588 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006589 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006590 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006591 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6592 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6593 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6594 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006595
6596 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6597 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6598 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6599 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6600 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6601 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6602
6603 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6604 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6605 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6606
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006607 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006608
6609
6610timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006611 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6613 yes | yes | yes | yes
6614 Arguments :
6615 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6616 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6617 as explained at the top of this document.
6618
6619 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6620 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6621 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6622
6623 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6624 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6625 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6626 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006627 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006628
6629 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6630
6631
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006632timeout tunnel <timeout>
6633 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6635 yes | no | yes | yes
6636 Arguments :
6637 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6638 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6639 as explained at the top of this document.
6640
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006641 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006642 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6643 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6644 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6645 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6646 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6647 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6648 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6649 specified.
6650
6651 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6652 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6653 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6654 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6655 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6656
6657 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6658 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6659 forget about it.
6660
6661 Example :
6662 defaults http
6663 option http-server-close
6664 timeout connect 5s
6665 timeout client 30s
6666 timeout client 30s
6667 timeout server 30s
6668 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6669
6670 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6671
6672
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006673transparent (deprecated)
6674 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006676 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006677 Arguments : none
6678
6679 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6680 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6681 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6682 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6683 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6684 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6685 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6686 appropriate server.
6687
6688 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6689
6690 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6691 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6692
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006693 See also: "option transparent"
6694
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006695unique-id-format <string>
6696 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6698 yes | yes | yes | no
6699 Arguments :
6700 <string> is a log-format string.
6701
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006702 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6703 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6704 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6705 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006706
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006707 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6708 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6709 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6710 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6711 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6712 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6713 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6714 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006715
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006716 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6717 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006718
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006719 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006720
6721 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6722
6723 will generate:
6724
6725 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6726
6727 See also: "unique-id-header"
6728
6729unique-id-header <name>
6730 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6732 yes | yes | yes | no
6733 Arguments :
6734 <name> is the name of the header.
6735
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006736 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6737 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006738
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006739 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006740
6741 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6742 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6743
6744 will generate:
6745
6746 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6747
6748 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006749
6750use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6751use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006752 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6754 no | yes | yes | no
6755 Arguments :
6756 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6757
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006758 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006759
6760 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6761 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6762 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006763 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6764 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6765 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6766 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006767
6768 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6769 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6770 assign the backend.
6771
6772 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6773 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6774 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6775 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6776 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6777 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6778
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006779 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006780 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006781 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6782 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6783 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6784
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006785 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006786
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006787
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006788use-server <server> if <condition>
6789use-server <server> unless <condition>
6790 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6792 no | no | yes | yes
6793 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006794 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006795
6796 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6797
6798 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6799 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6800 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6801
6802 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6803 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6804 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6805 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6806 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6807 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6808 matches will assign the server.
6809
6810 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6811 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6812 with the next rules until one matches.
6813
6814 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6815 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6816 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6817 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6818
6819 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6820 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6821 stripped.
6822
6823 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6824 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6825 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6826 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6827
6828 Example :
6829 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6830 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6831 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6832 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6833 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6834 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6835 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6836 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6837 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6838
6839 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6840
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006841
68425. Bind and Server options
6843--------------------------
6844
6845The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
6846depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
6847settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
6848written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
6849described in this section.
6850
6851
68525.1. Bind options
6853-----------------
6854
6855The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
6856as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
6857no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
6858parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
6859while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
6860provided immediately after the setting name.
6861
6862The currently supported settings are the following ones.
6863
6864accept-proxy
6865 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
6866 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
6867 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
6868 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
6869 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
6870 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
6871 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
6872 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
6873 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
6874 usable.
6875
6876backlog <backlog>
6877 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
6878 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
6879
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02006880ecdhe <named curve>
6881 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6882 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys and makes
6883 ECDHE cipher suites usable.
6884
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006885ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006886 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6887 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
6888 client's certificate.
6889
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006890ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
6891 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6892 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
6893 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
6894 error is ignored.
6895
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006896ciphers <ciphers>
6897 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6898 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
6899 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
6900 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
6901 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
6902
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006903crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006904 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6905 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
6906 to verify client's certificate.
6907
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006908crt <cert>
6909 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6910 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
6911 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006912 files into one. If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters
6913 present in this file are also loaded. If a directory name is used instead of a
6914 PEM file, then all files found in that directory will be loaded. This
6915 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
6916 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
6917 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN
6918 or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is
6919 used instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006920 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006921 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the client
6922 provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first loaded
6923 certificate will be presented. This means that when loading certificates from
6924 a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default one first as a file.
6925 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006926
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006927crt-ignore-err <errors>
6928 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6929 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
6930 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an
6931 error is ignored.
6932
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006933defer-accept
6934 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
6935 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
6936 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
6937 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
6938 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
6939 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
6940 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
6941 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
6942 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
6943 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
6944 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
6945
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006946force-sslv3
6947 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6948 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
6949 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6950
6951force-tlsv10
6952 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6953 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6954
6955force-tlsv11
6956 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6957 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6958
6959force-tlsv12
6960 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6961 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6962
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006963gid <gid>
6964 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
6965 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
6966 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
6967 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
6968 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6969
6970group <group>
6971 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
6972 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
6973 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
6974 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
6975 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6976
6977id <id>
6978 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
6979 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
6980 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
6981 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
6982
6983interface <interface>
6984 Sets the name of the network interface to listen. This is currently only
6985 supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system interface, not an
6986 aliased interface. When specified, all addresses on the same line will only
6987 be accepted if the incoming packets physically come through the designated
6988 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to the same address
6989 if they are bound to different interfaces. Note that binding to a network
6990 interface requires root privileges. This parameter is only compatible with
6991 TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
6992
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02006993level <level>
6994 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
6995 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
6996 sockets. <level> can be one of :
6997 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
6998 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
6999 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7000 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7001 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7002 counters).
7003 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7004 all counters).
7005
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007006maxconn <maxconn>
7007 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7008 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7009 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7010 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7011 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7012 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7013 eat all memory.
7014
7015mode <mode>
7016 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7017 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7018 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7019 UNIX sockets.
7020
7021mss <maxseg>
7022 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7023 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7024 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7025 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7026 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7027 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7028 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7029 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7030 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7031 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7032 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7033
7034name <name>
7035 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7036 page.
7037
7038nice <nice>
7039 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7040 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7041 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7042 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7043 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7044 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7045 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7046 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7047 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7048 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7049 one for an RDP socket.
7050
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007051no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007052 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7053 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7054 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007055 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7056 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007057
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007058no-tls-tickets
7059 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7060 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7061 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7062 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7063
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007064no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007065 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007066 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7067 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7068 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7069 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007070
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007071no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007072 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007073 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7074 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7075 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7076 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007077
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007078no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007079 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007080 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7081 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7082 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7083 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007084
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007085npn <protocols>
7086 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7087 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7088 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7089 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
7090 enabled (check with haproxy -vv).
7091
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007092ssl
7093 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7094 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7095 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7096 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7097 to deciphered contents.
7098
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007099tfo
7100 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.6. It
7101 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7102 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7103 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7104 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7105 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7106 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7107 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
7108 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7109
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007110transparent
7111 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7112 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7113 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7114 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7115 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7116 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7117 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7118 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7119 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7120 so check for support with your vendor.
7121
7122uid <uid>
7123 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7124 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7125 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7126 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7127 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7128
7129user <user>
7130 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7131 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7132 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7133 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7134 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7135
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007136verify [none|optional|required]
7137 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7138 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7139 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7140 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7141 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007142 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7143 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7144 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7145 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007146
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020071475.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007148------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007149
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007150The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7151which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7152arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7153settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7154after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7155Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7156address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007157
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007158 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007159 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007160
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007161The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007162
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007163addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007164 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7165 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7166 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7167 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7168 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007169
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007170 Supported in default-server: No
7171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007172backup
7173 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7174 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7175 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7176 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7177 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7178 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007179
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007180 Supported in default-server: No
7181
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007182ca-file <cafile>
7183 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7184 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7185 server's certificate.
7186
7187 Supported in default-server: No
7188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007189check
7190 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007191 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7192 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7193 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7194 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7195 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7196 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7197 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
7198 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
7199 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
7200 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007201
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007202 Supported in default-server: No
7203
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007204check-send-proxy
7205 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7206 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7207 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7208 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7209 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7210 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7211 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7212
7213 Supported in default-server: No
7214
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007215check-ssl
7216 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7217 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7218 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7219 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7220 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7221 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7222 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7223 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7224 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7225
7226 Supported in default-server: No
7227
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007228ciphers <ciphers>
7229 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7230 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7231 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7232 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7233 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7234 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7235 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7236 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7237
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007238 Supported in default-server: No
7239
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007240cookie <value>
7241 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7242 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7243 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7244 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7245 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7246 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7247 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7248
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007249 Supported in default-server: No
7250
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007251crl-file <crlfile>
7252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7253 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7254 to verify server's certificate.
7255
7256 Supported in default-server: No
7257
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007258crt <cert>
7259 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7260 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7261 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7262 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7263 certificate request.
7264
7265 Supported in default-server: No
7266
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007267disabled
7268 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7269 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7270 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7271 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7272 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7273
7274 Supported in default-server: No
7275
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007276error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007277 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7278 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7279 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007280
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007281 Supported in default-server: Yes
7282
7283 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007284
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007285fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007286 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7287 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7288 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7289
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007290 Supported in default-server: Yes
7291
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007292force-sslv3
7293 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7294 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7295 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7296
7297 Supported in default-server: No
7298
7299force-tlsv10
7300 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7301 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7302
7303 Supported in default-server: No
7304
7305force-tlsv11
7306 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7307 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7308
7309 Supported in default-server: No
7310
7311force-tlsv12
7312 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7313 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7314
7315 Supported in default-server: No
7316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007317id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007318 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7319 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7320 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007322 Supported in default-server: No
7323
7324inter <delay>
7325fastinter <delay>
7326downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007327 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7328 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7329 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7330 between checks depending on the server state :
7331
7332 Server state | Interval used
7333 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7334 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7335 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7336 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7337 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7338 or yet unchecked. |
7339 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7340 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7341 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007343 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7344 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7345 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7346 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7347 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7348 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7349 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7350 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7351 servers.
7352
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007353 Supported in default-server: Yes
7354
7355maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007356 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7357 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7358 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7359 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7360 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7361 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7362 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7363 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007365 Supported in default-server: Yes
7366
7367maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007368 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7369 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7370 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7371 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7372 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7373 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7374 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007376 Supported in default-server: Yes
7377
7378minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007379 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7380 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7381 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7382 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7383 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7384 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007385 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007386 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007387
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007388 Supported in default-server: Yes
7389
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007390no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007391 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7392 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007393 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007394
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007395 Supported in default-server: No
7396
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007397no-tls-tickets
7398 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7399 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7400 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7401 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7402
7403 Supported in default-server: No
7404
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007405no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007406 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007407 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7408 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007409 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7410 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007411
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007412 Supported in default-server: No
7413
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007414no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007415 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007416 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7417 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007418 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7419 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007420
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007421 Supported in default-server: No
7422
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007423no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007424 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007425 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7426 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007427 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7428 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007429
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007430 Supported in default-server: No
7431
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007432non-stick
7433 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7434 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7435 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7436
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007437 Supported in default-server: No
7438
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007439observe <mode>
7440 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7441 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7442 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7443 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7444 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7445 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007446 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007447
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007448 Supported in default-server: No
7449
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007450 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7451
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007452on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007453 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7454 Currently, four modes are available:
7455 - fastinter: force fastinter
7456 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7457 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7458 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7459 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7460
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007461 Supported in default-server: Yes
7462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007463 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7464
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007465on-marked-down <action>
7466 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7467 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007468 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7469 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7470 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7471 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7472 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7473 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7474 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7475 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007476
7477 Actions are disabled by default
7478
7479 Supported in default-server: Yes
7480
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007481on-marked-up <action>
7482 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7483 Currently one action is available:
7484 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7485 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7486 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7487 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7488 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7489 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7490 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7491 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7492
7493 Actions are disabled by default
7494
7495 Supported in default-server: Yes
7496
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007497port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007498 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7499 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7500 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7501 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7502 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7503 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7504
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007505 Supported in default-server: Yes
7506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007507redir <prefix>
7508 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7509 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7510 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7511 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7512 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7513 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7514 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7515 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007516 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007517 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7518 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7519 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7520 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7521 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7522
7523 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7524
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007525 Supported in default-server: No
7526
7527rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007528 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7529 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7530 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7531
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007532 Supported in default-server: Yes
7533
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007534send-proxy
7535 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7536 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7537 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7538 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7539 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7540 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7541 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7542 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7543 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007544 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
7545 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
7546 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
7547 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
7548 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007549
7550 Supported in default-server: No
7551
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007552slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007553 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7554 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7555 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7556 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7557 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7558 parameters :
7559
7560 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7561 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7562
7563 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7564 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7565 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7566 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7567
7568 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7569 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7570 seen as failed.
7571
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007572 Supported in default-server: Yes
7573
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007574source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007575source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007576source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007577 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7578 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7579 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7580 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7581
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007582 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7583 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7584 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7585 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7586 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7587 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7588 server.
7589
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007590 Supported in default-server: No
7591
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007592ssl
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007593 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7594 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7595 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7596 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7597 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications. When this
7598 option is used, health checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there
7599 is a "port" or an "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a
7600 different location. See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
7601
7602 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007604track [<proxy>/]<server>
7605 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7606 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7607 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7608 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7609 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007611 Supported in default-server: No
7612
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007613verify [none|required]
7614 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7615 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
7616 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
7617 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7618 is aborted.
7619
7620 Supported in default-server: No
7621
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007622weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007623 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7624 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7625 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007626 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7627 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7628 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7629 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7630 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7631 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007632
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007633 Supported in default-server: Yes
7634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007635
76366. HTTP header manipulation
7637---------------------------
7638
7639In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7640response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7641request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7642which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7643against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7644to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7645passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7646headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7647never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7648
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007649There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7650(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7651rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7652messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7653in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007654happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007655add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7656normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7657
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007658This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7659in section 4.2 :
7660
7661 - reqadd <string>
7662 - reqallow <search>
7663 - reqiallow <search>
7664 - reqdel <search>
7665 - reqidel <search>
7666 - reqdeny <search>
7667 - reqideny <search>
7668 - reqpass <search>
7669 - reqipass <search>
7670 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7671 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7672 - reqtarpit <search>
7673 - reqitarpit <search>
7674 - rspadd <string>
7675 - rspdel <search>
7676 - rspidel <search>
7677 - rspdeny <search>
7678 - rspideny <search>
7679 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7680 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7681
7682With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7683is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7684parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7685prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7686Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7687
7688 \t for a tab
7689 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7690 \n for a new line (LF)
7691 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7692 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7693 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7694 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7695 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7696
7697The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7698portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7699above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7700regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
77019 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7702is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7703
7704The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7705after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7706
7707Notes related to these keywords :
7708---------------------------------
7709 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7710 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7711 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7712
7713 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7714 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7715 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7716
7717 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7718 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7719 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7720 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7721 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7722
7723 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7724 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7725 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7726 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7727 useless headers before adding new ones.
7728
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007729 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007730 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7731
7732 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7733 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7734 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7735
7736 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7737 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007738 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007739
7740
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010077417. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7742------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007743
7744The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7745content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7746from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7747simple :
7748
7749 - define test criteria with sets of values
7750 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7751
7752The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7753
7754In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7755
7756 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7757
7758This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7759Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7760and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7761an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7762of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7763
7764ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7765'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7766which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7767
7768There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7769performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7770
7771The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7772
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007773 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7774 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007775 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7776
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007777The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7778specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7779possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007780multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7781be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7782needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7783space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7784match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7785lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7786duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007787to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007788instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007789
7790 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7791
7792In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7793the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7794case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7795too.
7796
7797Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7798a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7799ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7800
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007801Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007802
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007803 - integers or integer ranges
7804 - strings
7805 - regular expressions
7806 - IP addresses and networks
7807
7808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078097.1. Matching integers
7810----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007811
7812Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7813that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7814expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7815may be omitted.
7816
7817For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7818unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7819representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7820
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007821As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7822two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7823instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7824ranges and operators.
7825
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007826For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007827operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7828Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7829of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007830
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007831Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007832
7833 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7834 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7835 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7836 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7837 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7838
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007839For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007840
7841 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7842
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007843This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7844
7845 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7846
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007847
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078487.2. Matching strings
7849---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007850
7851String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7852exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7853characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7854string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7855to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007856before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007857
7858
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078597.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7860-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007861
7862Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7863they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7864possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7865passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7866the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007867the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7868match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007869
7870
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020078717.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007872----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007873
7874IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7875netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7876within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007877host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007878difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7879at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7880does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7881parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007882
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007883IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7884Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7885trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7886IPv6 patterns.
7887
7888HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7889following situations :
7890 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7891 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7892 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7893 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7894 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7895 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7896 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7897 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7898 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7899 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7900
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007901
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079027.5. Available matching criteria
7903--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007904
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079057.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7906------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007907
7908A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7909analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007910addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007911
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007912always_false
7913 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7914 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7915
7916always_true
7917 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7918 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7919
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007920avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007921avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007922 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7923 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7924 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7925 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7926 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7927 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7928 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7929 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7930 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7931 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7932 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007933
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007934be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007935be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007936 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7937 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7938 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7939 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7940 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007941
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007942be_id <integer>
7943 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7944 backend it was called.
7945
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007946be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007947be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007948 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7949 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7950 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7951 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7952 sucking of an online dictionary).
7953
7954 Example :
7955 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7956 backend dynamic
7957 mode http
7958 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7959 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007960
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007961connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007962connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007963 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007964 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007965 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7966
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007967 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7968 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007969
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007970 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007971 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7972 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7973 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7974 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7975 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007976 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007977
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007978 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7979 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7980 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7981 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007982
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007983dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007984 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7985 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007986
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007987dst_conn <integer>
7988 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7989 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7990 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7991 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7992 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7993 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7994
7995dst_port <integer>
7996 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7997 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7998
7999fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008000fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008001 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
8002 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
8003 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8004 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
8005 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
8006 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
8007 criteria.
8008
8009fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008010 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008011 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008012
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008013fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008014fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008015 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
8016 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
8017 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
8018 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
8019 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
8020 the rate to go down below the limit.
8021
8022 Example :
8023 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
8024 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
8025 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
8026 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
8027 frontend mail
8028 bind :25
8029 mode tcp
8030 maxconn 100
8031 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
8032 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
8033 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
8034 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008035
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008036nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008037nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008038 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
8039 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
8040 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
8041 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
8042 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008043
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008044queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008045queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008046 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
8047 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
8048 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
8049 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
8050 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
8051 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
8052 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
8053
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008054sc1_bytes_in_rate
8055sc2_bytes_in_rate
8056 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
8057 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8058 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
8059
8060sc1_bytes_out_rate
8061sc2_bytes_out_rate
8062 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
8063 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8064 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
8065
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008066sc1_clr_gpc0
8067sc2_clr_gpc0
8068 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
8069 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
8070 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
8071 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
8072 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
8073 was verified :
8074
8075 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8076 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8077 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8078 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8079 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
8080 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8081 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8082
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008083sc1_conn_cnt
8084sc2_conn_cnt
8085 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
8086 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
8087
8088sc1_conn_cur
8089sc2_conn_cur
8090 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8091 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8092 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
8093
8094sc1_conn_rate
8095sc2_conn_rate
8096 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
8097 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
8098 See also src_conn_rate.
8099
8100sc1_get_gpc0
8101sc2_get_gpc0
8102 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8103 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
8104
8105sc1_http_err_cnt
8106sc2_http_err_cnt
8107 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
8108 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
8109 See also src_http_err_cnt.
8110
8111sc1_http_err_rate
8112sc2_http_err_rate
8113 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
8114 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
8115 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
8116 src_http_err_rate.
8117
8118sc1_http_req_cnt
8119sc2_http_req_cnt
8120 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8121 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8122 src_http_req_cnt.
8123
8124sc1_http_req_rate
8125sc2_http_req_rate
8126 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8127 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
8128 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8129 src_http_req_rate.
8130
8131sc1_inc_gpc0
8132sc2_inc_gpc0
8133 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
8134 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
8135 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
8136 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
8137 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
8138 when a first ACL was verified :
8139
8140 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8141 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
8142 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8143
8144sc1_kbytes_in
8145sc2_kbytes_in
8146 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
8147 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8148 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8149 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
8150
8151sc1_kbytes_out
8152sc2_kbytes_out
8153 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
8154 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8155 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8156 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
8157
8158sc1_sess_cnt
8159sc2_sess_cnt
8160 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
8161 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
8162 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
8163 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008164 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008165 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
8166
8167sc1_sess_rate
8168sc2_sess_rate
8169 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
8170 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
8171 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
8172 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
8173 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008174 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008175
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008176so_id <integer>
8177 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
8178
8179src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008180 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
8181 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
8182 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008183
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008184src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008185src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008186 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8187 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8188 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008189 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008190
8191src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008192src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008193 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
8194 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8195 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008196 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008197
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008198src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8199src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
8200 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8201 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8202 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
8203 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
8204 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
8205 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8206
8207 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8208 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8209 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8210 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8211 acl save src_clr_gpc0
8212 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8213 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8214
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008215src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008216src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008217 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8218 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8219 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008220 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008221
8222src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008223src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008224 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
8225 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
8226 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008227 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008228
8229src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008230src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008231 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
8232 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8233 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008234 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008235
8236src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008237src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008238 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8239 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8240 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008241 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008242
8243src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008244src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008245 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
8246 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8247 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008248 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008249
8250src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008251src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008252 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
8253 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
8254 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
8255 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008256 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008257
8258src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008259src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008260 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8261 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8262 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008263 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008264
8265src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008266src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008267 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8268 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8269 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
8270 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008271 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008272
8273src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008274src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008275 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8276 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8277 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
8278 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
8279 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
8280 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8281
8282 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8283 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008284 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008285
8286src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008287src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008288 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
8289 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8290 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8291 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008292 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008293
8294src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008295src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008296 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
8297 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8298 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8299 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008300 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008301
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008302src_port <integer>
8303 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008304
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008305src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008306src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008307 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8308 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
8309 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
8310 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008311 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008312
8313src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008314src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008315 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8316 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8317 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
8318 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008319 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008320
8321src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008322src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008323 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008324 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
8325 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008326 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
8327 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
8328 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008329 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008330
8331 Example :
8332 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
8333 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
8334 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
8335 listen ssh
8336 bind :22
8337 mode tcp
8338 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008339 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008340 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
8341 server local 127.0.0.1:22
8342
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008343srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02008344 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
8345 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
8346 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
8347 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
8348
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008349srv_id <integer>
8350 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
8351
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02008352srv_is_up(<server>)
8353srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
8354 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8355 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8356 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
8357 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
8358 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
8359 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8360 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8361 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8362
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008363table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008364table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008365 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8366 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8367
8368table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008369table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008370 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8371 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8372 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008374
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020083757.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8376---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008377
8378A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8379during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008380through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8381keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008382
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008383rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8384 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8385 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8386 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008387 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8388 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8389 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008390
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008391req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008392 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008393 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8394 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8395 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8396 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8397 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8398 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8399
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008400req_proto_http
8401 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8402 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008403 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008404 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8405 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8406
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008407req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008408req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008409 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8410 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8411 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8412 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8413 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8414 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8415 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8416 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8417
8418req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008419req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008420 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8421 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8422 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8423 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8424 cookies.
8425
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008426req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8427 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8428 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8429 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008430 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8431 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8432 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008433
8434req_ssl_sni <string>
8435 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8436 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8437 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8438 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8439 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8440 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8441 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008442 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8443 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008444 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008445 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008446
8447 Examples :
8448 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8449 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8450 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8451 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8452 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8453
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008454req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8455 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8456 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8457 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8458 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8459 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8460 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008461 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8462 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008463 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008464 option.
8465
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008466ssl_c_ca_err <integer>
8467 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8468 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification of the
8469 client certificate at depth > 0 matches the specified value (check man verify
8470 for possible values). Note that error zero means no error was encountered
8471 during this verification process.
8472
8473ssl_c_ca_err_depth <integer>
8474 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8475 layer, and the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
8476 verification of the client certificate matches the specified value. When no
8477 error is found, depth 0 is returned.
8478
8479ssl_c_err <integer>
8480 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8481 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth==0
8482 matches the specified value (check man verify for possible values). Note that
8483 error zero means no error was encountered during this verification process.
8484
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008485ssl_c_i_dn <string>
8486ssl_c_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8487 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8488 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8489 issuer of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8490 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8491 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8492 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8493 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8494 DN matches the specified string.
8495
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008496ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8497 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8498 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8499 certificate presented by the client matches the string.
8500
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008501ssl_c_notafter <string>
8502 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8503 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8504 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8505
8506ssl_c_notbefore <string>
8507 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8508 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8509 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8510
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008511ssl_c_s_dn <string>
8512ssl_c_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8513 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8514 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8515 subject of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8516 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8517 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8518 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8519 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8520 DN matches the specified string.
8521
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008522ssl_c_serial <hexa>
8523 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8524 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the client matches
8525 the value written in hexa.
8526
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008527ssl_c_sig_alg <string>
8528 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8529 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8530 by the client matches the string.
8531
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008532ssl_c_verify <integer>
8533 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8534 layer, and the verify result matches the specified value (check man verify
8535 for possible values). Zero indicates no error was detected.
8536
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008537ssl_c_version <integer>
8538 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8539 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the client matches
8540 the value.
8541
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008542ssl_f_i_dn <string>
8543ssl_f_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8544 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8545 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8546 issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8547 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8548 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8549 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8550 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8551 DN matches the specified string.
8552
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008553ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8554 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8555 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8556 certificate presented by the frontend matches the string.
8557
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008558ssl_f_notafter <string>
8559 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8560 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8561 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8562
8563ssl_f_notbefore <string>
8564 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8565 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8566 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8567
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008568ssl_f_s_dn <string>
8569ssl_f_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8570 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8571 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8572 subject of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8573 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8574 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8575 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8576 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8577 DN matches the specified string.
8578
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008579ssl_f_serial <hexa>
8580 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8581 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8582 the value written in hexa.
8583
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008584ssl_f_sig_alg <string>
8585 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8586 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8587 by the frontend matches the string.
8588
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008589ssl_f_version <integer>
8590 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8591 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8592 the value.
8593
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008594ssl_fc
8595 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8596 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
8597 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
8598
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008599ssl_fc_alg_keysize <integer>
8600 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8601 layer and the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits matches the value.
8602
8603ssl_fc_cipher <string>
8604 returns true when the incoming connection was made over an ssl/tls transport
8605 layer and the name of the used cipher matches the string.
8606
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008607ssl_fc_has_crt
8608 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
8609 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
8610
8611ssl_fc_has_sni
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008612 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008613 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
8614 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
8615 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8616 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008617
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008618ssl_fc_npn <string>
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008619 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8620 layer which deciphered it and found a Next Protocol Negociation TLS extension
8621 sent by the client, matching the specified string. This requires that the SSL
8622 library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008623 Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on
8624 the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to
8625 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be requested.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008626
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008627ssl_fc_protocol <string>
8628 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8629 layer and the name of the used protocol matches the string.
8630
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008631ssl_fc_sni <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008632 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8633 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8634 sent by the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8635 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008636 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8637 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008638 See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_req" below. This requires that the
8639 SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8640 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008641
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008642ssl_fc_sni_end <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008643 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8644 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8645 sent by the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8646 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008647 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8648 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8649 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8650 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008651
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008652ssl_fc_sni_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008653 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8654 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8655 sent by the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8656 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008657 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8658 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8659 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8660 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008661
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008662ssl_fc_use_keysize <integer>
8663 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8664 layer and the symmetric cipher key size used in bits matches the value.
8665
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008666wait_end
8667 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8668 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8669 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8670 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8671 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8672 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8673 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8674 inspection.
8675
8676 Examples :
8677 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8678 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8679 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8680
8681 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8682 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8683 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8684 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8685 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8686 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8687 tcp-request content reject
8688
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086907.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8691--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008692
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008693A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008694application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8695read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8696than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8697
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008698base <string>
8699 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8700 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8701 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8702 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8703 See also "path" and "uri".
8704
8705base_beg <string>
8706 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8707 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8708 "path_beg".
8709
8710base_dir <string>
8711 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8712 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8713 "path_dir" instead.
8714
8715base_dom <string>
8716 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8717 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8718 instead.
8719
8720base_end <string>
8721 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8722 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8723
8724base_len <integer>
8725 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8726 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8727
8728base_reg <regex>
8729 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8730 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8731 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8732 and all "base_" criteria.
8733
8734base_sub <string>
8735 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8736 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8737 also "base_dir".
8738
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008739cook(<name>) <string>
8740 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8741 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8742 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8743 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8744 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8745 sent by the server.
8746
8747 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8748 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8749 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8750
8751 cook(profile) silver gold
8752
8753cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8754 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8755 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8756 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8757
8758cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8759 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8760 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8761 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8762 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8763 server.
8764
8765cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8766 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8767 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8768 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8769 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8770 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8771
8772cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8773 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8774 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8775 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8776 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8777
8778cook_end(<name>) <string>
8779 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8780 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8781 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8782
8783cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8784 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8785 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8786 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8787 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8788 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8789
8790cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8791 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8792 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8793 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8794 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8795 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8796
8797cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8798 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8799 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8800 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8801
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008802cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8803 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8804 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8805 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8806 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8807 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8808
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008809hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008810hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008811 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8812 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8813 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8814 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008815 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8816 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8817 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8818 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8819 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008820
8821 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008822 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008823 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8824
8825 hdr(Connection) -i close
8826
8827hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008828hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008829 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8830 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8831 response headers sent by the server.
8832
8833hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008834hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008835 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8836 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8837 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8838 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8839 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8840 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8841 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8842
8843hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008844hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008845 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8846 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8847 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8848 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8849 headers sent by the server.
8850
8851hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008852hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008853 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8854 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8855 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8856 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8857 server.
8858
8859hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008860hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008861 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8862 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8863 response headers sent by the server.
8864
8865hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008866hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8867 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8868 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8869 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008870 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8871
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008872hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008873hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008874 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8875 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8876 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8877 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8878
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008879hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008880hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008881 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008882 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8883 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8884 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8885 response headers sent by the server.
8886
8887hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008888hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008889 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8890 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8891 response headers sent by the server.
8892
8893hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008894hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008895 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8896 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8897 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8898 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8899
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008900http_auth(<userlist>)
8901http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008902 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8903 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8904 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8905 of specified groups.
8906
8907 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8908
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008909http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008910 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8911 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8912 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8913 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8914
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008915method <string>
8916 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8917 already check for most common methods.
8918
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008919path <string>
8920 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8921 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8922 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8923
8924path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008925 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8926 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008927
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008928path_dir <string>
8929 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8930 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8931 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8932 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8933
8934path_dom <string>
8935 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8936 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8937 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8938
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008939path_end <string>
8940 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8941 control file name extension.
8942
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008943path_len <integer>
8944 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8945 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8946
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008947path_reg <regex>
8948 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8949 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8950 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8951
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008952path_sub <string>
8953 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8954 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8955 "path_dir".
8956
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008957payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8958 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8959 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8960 strings.
8961
8962payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8963 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8964 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8965 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8966 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8967 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8968
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008969req_ver <string>
8970 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8971 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8972
8973status <integer>
8974 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8975 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8976 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8977
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008978url <string>
8979 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008980 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008981
8982url_beg <string>
8983 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008984 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
8985 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008986
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008987url_dir <string>
8988 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8989 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8990 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8991 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8992
8993url_dom <string>
8994 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8995 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8996 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8997
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008998url_end <string>
8999 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
9000 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009001
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009002url_ip <address>
9003 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
9004 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
9005 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009006
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009007url_len <integer>
9008 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
9009 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9010
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009011url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009012 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
9013 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009014 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009015 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009016
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009017url_reg <regex>
9018 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
9019 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009020 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009021
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009022url_sub <string>
9023 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
9024 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009025
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009026urlp(<name>) <string>
9027 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
9028 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
9029
9030 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
9031 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
9032
9033urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
9034 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
9035 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
9036 protocol scheme.
9037
9038urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
9039 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
9040 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
9041 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
9042 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
9043
9044urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
9045 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9046 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
9047 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
9048 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
9049
9050urlp_end(<name>) <string>
9051 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
9052
9053urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009054 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
9055 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009056
9057urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
9058 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
9059 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9060
9061urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
9062 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
9063 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
9064 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
9065 "urlp_" criteria.
9066
9067urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
9068 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
9069 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
9070 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
9071
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02009072urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
9073 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
9074 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
9075 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
9076 negative data.
9077
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009078
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090797.6. Pre-defined ACLs
9080---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009081
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009082Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
9083every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009084order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009086ACL name Equivalent to Usage
9087---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009088FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009089HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009090HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
9091HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009092HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
9093HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
9094HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
9095HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
9096LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009097METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
9098METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
9099METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
9100METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
9101METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
9102METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009103RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009104REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009105TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009106WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
9107---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009108
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091107.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
9111----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009113Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9114combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009116 - AND (implicit)
9117 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9118 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009119
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009120A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009122 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009123
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009124Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9125indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009126
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009127For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9128"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9129requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9130is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009131
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009132 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9133 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9134 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9135 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009136
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009137To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9138and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009140 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9141 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9142 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9143 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009145 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9146 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9147 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9148 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009149
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009150It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9151expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9152be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009153the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009154
9155 The following rule :
9156
9157 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9158 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9159
9160 Can also be written that way :
9161
9162 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9163
9164It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9165to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9166simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9167sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9168good use is the following :
9169
9170 With named ACLs :
9171
9172 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9173 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9174 monitor fail if site_dead
9175
9176 With anonymous ACLs :
9177
9178 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009180See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009181
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01009182
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010091837.8. Pattern extraction
9184-----------------------
9185
9186The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
9187response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
9188for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
9189
9190All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
9191"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
9192begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
9193arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
9194much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
9195equivalent used in ACLs.
9196
9197The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
9198
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009199 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
9200 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
9201 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
9202 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
9203 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
9204 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9205 requested objects by host/path.
9206
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009207 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009208 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9209 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9210 according to RFC 4291.
9211
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009212 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
9213 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
9214 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009215 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9216 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9217 according to RFC 4291.
9218
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009219 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
9220 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
9221 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
9222 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
9223 type integer and only works with such tables.
9224
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009225 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
9226 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
9227 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
9228 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
9229 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
9230 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
9231 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01009232 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02009233
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009234 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
9235 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9236 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9237 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
9238 wiser to use "url" instead.
9239
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009240 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009241 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
9242 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
9243 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
9244 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009245
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009246 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009247 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
9248 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
9249 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
9250 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
9251 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
9252 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
9253 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
9254 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009255
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009256 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
9257 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
9258 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
9259 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
9260
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009261 ssl_c_ca_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9262 client certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was detected.
9263
9264 ssl_c_ca_err_depth
9265 Returns the depth of the first error detected during verify. If
9266 no error is encountered in the CA chain, zero is returned.
9267
9268 ssl_c_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9269 client certificate at depth == 0, or 0 if no errors.
9270
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009271 ssl_c_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9272 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9273 the issuer of the certificate presented by the client when
9274 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9275 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9276 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9277 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9278 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9279 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9280 name ssl_c_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9281 ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2).
9282
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009283 ssl_c_key_alg
9284 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9285 the certificate presented by the client when the incoming
9286 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9287
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009288 ssl_c_notafter
9289 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted
9290 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9291 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9292
9293 ssl_c_notbefore
9294 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted
9295 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9296 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9297
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009298 ssl_c_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9299 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9300 the subject of the certificate presented by the client when
9301 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9302 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9303 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9304 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9305 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9306 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9307 name ssl_c_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9308 ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2).
9309
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009310 ssl_c_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client
9311 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9312 layer.
9313
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009314 ssl_c_sig_alg
9315 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9316 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made
9317 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9318
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009319 ssl_c_verify Returns the verify result errorID when the incoming connection
9320 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no
9321 error is encountered.
9322
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009323 ssl_c_version
9324 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client
9325 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9326 layer.
9327
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009328 ssl_f_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9329 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9330 the issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9331 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9332 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9333 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9334 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9335 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9336 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9337 name ssl_f_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9338 ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2).
9339
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009340 ssl_f_key_alg
9341 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9342 the certificate presented by the frontend when the incoming
9343 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9344
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009345 ssl_f_notafter
9346 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9347 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9348 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9349
9350 ssl_f_notbefore
9351 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9352 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9353 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9354
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009355 ssl_f_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9356 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9357 the subject of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9358 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9359 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9360 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9361 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9362 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9363 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9364 name ssl_f_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9365 ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2).
9366
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009367 ssl_f_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend
9368 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9369 layer.
9370
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009371 ssl_f_sig_alg
9372 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9373 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made
9374 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9375
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009376 ssl_f_version
9377 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend
9378 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9379 layer.
9380
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009381 ssl_fc This checks the transport layer used on the front connection,
9382 and returns 1 if it was made via an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9383 otherwise zero.
9384
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009385 ssl_fc_alg_keysize
9386 Returns the symmetric cipher key size support d in bits when the
9387 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9388
9389 ssl_fc_cipher
9390 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection
9391 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9392
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009393 ssl_fc_has_crt
9394 Returns 1 if a client certificate is present in the front
9395 connection over SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise 0.
9396
9397 ssl_fc_has_sni
9398 This checks the transport layer used by the front connection, and
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009399 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9400 layer and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009401 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009402 support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009403
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009404 ssl_fc_npn This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009405 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and
9406 locally deciphered by haproxy. The result is a string containing
9407 the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL library must
9408 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009409 haproxy -vv). See also the "npn" bind keyword.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009410
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009411 ssl_fc_protocol
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01009412 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming
9413 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009414
Emeric Brunfe68f682012-10-16 14:59:28 +02009415 ssl_fc_session_id
9416 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming
9417 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful to
9418 stick on a given client.
9419
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009420 ssl_fc_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009421 connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9422 deciphered by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching
9423 the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must
9424 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9425 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009426
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009427 ssl_fc_use_keysize
9428 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the
9429 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9430
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009431 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
9432 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9433 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9434 keep them in caches. See also "path".
9435
9436 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
9437 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
9438 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
9439 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
9440 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
9441 table for a given source address.
9442
9443 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
9444 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
9445
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009446 url_param(<name>[,<delim>])
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009447 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009448 the parameter string of the request and uses the corresponding
9449 value to match. Optionally, a delimiter can be provided. If not
9450 then the question mark '?' is used by default.
9451 A typical use is to get sticky session through url for cases
9452 where cookies cannot be used.
9453
9454 Example :
9455 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
9456 stick on url_param(PHPSESSIONID)
9457 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
9458 stick on url_param(JSESSIONID,;)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09009459
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009460 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009461 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
9462 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
9463 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
9464 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009465
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009466 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
9467 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
9468 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
9469 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9470 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
9471 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
9472 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009473
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009474 Example :
9475 listen tse-farm
9476 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9477 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9478 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9479 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9480 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9481 persist rdp-cookie
9482 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9483 # This is only useful makes sense if
9484 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9485 stick-table type string size 204800
9486 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9487 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9488 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009489
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009490 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
9491 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009492
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009493 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009494 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009495 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
9496 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
9497 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
9498 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
9499 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9500 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009501
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009502 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009503
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009504 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009505 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
9506 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
9507 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
9508
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009509 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
9510 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
9511 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
9512 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
9513 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009514
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009515 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009516
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009517
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009518The currently available list of transformations include :
9519
9520 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
9521 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9522 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9523
9524 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
9525 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9526 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9527
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009528 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01009529 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
9530 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9531 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9532 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9533
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009534
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095358. Logging
9536----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009537
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009538One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
9539provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
9540very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
9541provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
9542state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009543to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009544headers.
9545
9546In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
9547about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
9548send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
9549
9550 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
9551 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
9552 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
9553 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
9554 at the termination.
9555
9556The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
9557allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
9558as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
9559while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
9560real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
9561delay.
9562
9563
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095648.1. Log levels
9565---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009566
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009567TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009568source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009569HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
9570in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
9571track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
9572syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
9573about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009574
9575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095768.2. Log formats
9577----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009578
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009579HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009580and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
9581slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
9582options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009583
9584 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
9585 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
9586 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
9587 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
9588 extents.
9589
9590 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
9591 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
9592 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
9593 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
9594 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
9595
9596 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
9597 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
9598 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
9599 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
9600 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
9601
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009602 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
9603 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
9604 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
9605 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
9606
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009607 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
9608
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009609Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
9610specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
9611field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
9612servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
9613always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
9614identifier.
9615
9616Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
9617 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
9618 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
9619 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
9620 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
9621
9622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096238.2.1. Default log format
9624-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009625
9626This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
9627as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
9628format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
9629
9630 Example :
9631 listen www
9632 mode http
9633 log global
9634 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9635
9636 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
9637 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
9638 (www/HTTP)
9639
9640 Field Format Extract from the example above
9641 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
9642 2 'Connect from' Connect from
9643 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
9644 4 'to' to
9645 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
9646 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
9647
9648Detailed fields description :
9649 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
9650 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
9651 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
9652 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
9653 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9654 and processed the connection.
9655 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
9656
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009657In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
9658"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
9659connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
9660
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009661It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
9662will eventually disappear.
9663
9664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096658.2.2. TCP log format
9666---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009667
9668The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
9669is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
9670information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
9671counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
9672emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
9673environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
9674the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
9675sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009676specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
9677not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
9678fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
9679marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009680
9681 Example :
9682 frontend fnt
9683 mode tcp
9684 option tcplog
9685 log global
9686 default_backend bck
9687
9688 backend bck
9689 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9690
9691 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9692 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9693 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9694
9695 Field Format Extract from the example above
9696 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9697 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9698 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9699 4 frontend_name fnt
9700 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9701 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9702 7 bytes_read* 212
9703 8 termination_state --
9704 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9705 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9706
9707Detailed fields description :
9708 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009709 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9710 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9711 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9712 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9713 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009714
9715 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009716 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9717 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9718 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009719
9720 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9721 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9722 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9723 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9724
9725 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9726 and processed the connection.
9727
9728 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9729 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9730 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9731 applications.
9732
9733 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9734 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9735 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9736 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9737 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9738
9739 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9740 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9741 See "Timers" below for more details.
9742
9743 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9744 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9745 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9746 "Timers" below for more details.
9747
9748 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9749 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9750 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9751 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9752 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9753 details.
9754
9755 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
9756 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
9757 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
9758 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
9759 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
9760
9761 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9762 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9763 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
9764 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
9765 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
9766 for more details.
9767
9768 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009769 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009770 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
9771 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
9772 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009773 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009774
9775 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9776 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9777 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9778 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9779 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9780 caused by a denial of service attack.
9781
9782 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9783 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9784 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9785 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9786 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9787 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9788 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9789 denial of service attack.
9790
9791 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9792 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9793 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9794 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9795 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9796 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9797 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9798 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
9799 be processed than on other servers.
9800
9801 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9802 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9803 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9804 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9805 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9806 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9807 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9808 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9809 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9810 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9811 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9812 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9813 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9814
9815 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9816 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9817 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9818 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9819 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9820 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9821 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9822 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9823
9824 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9825 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9826 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9827 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9828 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9829 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9830 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9831 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9832 occurs.
9833
9834
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098358.2.3. HTTP log format
9836----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009837
9838The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
9839is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
9840the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
9841are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
9842emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
9843generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
9844"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
9845which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009846frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
9847is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009848
9849Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
9850slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
9851with a star ('*') after the field name below.
9852
9853 Example :
9854 frontend http-in
9855 mode http
9856 option httplog
9857 log global
9858 default_backend bck
9859
9860 backend static
9861 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9862
9863 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9864 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9865 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009866 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009867
9868 Field Format Extract from the example above
9869 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
9870 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
9871 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
9872 4 frontend_name http-in
9873 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
9874 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
9875 7 status_code 200
9876 8 bytes_read* 2750
9877 9 captured_request_cookie -
9878 10 captured_response_cookie -
9879 11 termination_state ----
9880 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
9881 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9882 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
9883 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
9884 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009885
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009886
9887Detailed fields description :
9888 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009889 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9890 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9891 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9892 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9893 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009894
9895 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009896 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9897 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9898 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009899
9900 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
9901 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
9902 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
9903 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
9904 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
9905
9906 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9907 and processed the connection.
9908
9909 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9910 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9911 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
9912
9913 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9914 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9915 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9916 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
9917 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
9918 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
9919
9920 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
9921 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
9922 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
9923 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
9924 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
9925 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
9926
9927 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9928 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9929 See "Timers" below for more details.
9930
9931 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9932 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9933 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
9934 below for more details.
9935
9936 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
9937 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
9938 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
9939 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
9940 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
9941 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
9942 for more details.
9943
9944 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9945 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9946 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9947 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9948 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9949 details.
9950
9951 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
9952 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
9953 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
9954
9955 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
9956 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
9957 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
9958 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
9959 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
9960 overflowing.
9961
9962 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
9963 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
9964 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
9965 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
9966 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
9967 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
9968 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
9969 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9970
9971 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
9972 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
9973 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
9974 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
9975 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
9976 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
9977 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
9978 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9979
9980 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9981 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9982 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
9983 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
9984 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
9985 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
9986 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
9987
9988 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009989 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009990 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
9991 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
9992 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009993 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009994 system.
9995
9996 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9997 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9998 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9999 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10000 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10001 caused by a denial of service attack.
10002
10003 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10004 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10005 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10006 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10007 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10008 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10009 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10010 denial of service attack.
10011
10012 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10013 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10014 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10015 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10016 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10017 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10018 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10019 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
10020 processed than on other servers.
10021
10022 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10023 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10024 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10025 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10026 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10027 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10028 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10029 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10030 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10031 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10032 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10033 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10034 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10035
10036 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10037 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10038 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10039 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10040 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10041 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10042 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10043 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10044
10045 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10046 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10047 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10048 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10049 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10050 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10051 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10052 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10053 occurs.
10054
10055 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
10056 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
10057 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
10058 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
10059 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
10060 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
10061 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
10062 cookies" below for more details.
10063
10064 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
10065 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
10066 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
10067 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
10068 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
10069 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
10070 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
10071 and cookies" below for more details.
10072
10073 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
10074 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
10075 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
10076 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
10077 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
10078 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
10079 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
10080 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
10081
10082
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200100838.2.4. Custom log format
10084------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010085
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010086The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
10087mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010088
10089HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10090Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10091separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10092prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10093
10094Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10095variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10096string formats ("Q").
10097
10098Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10099HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10100
10101Flags are :
10102 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010103 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010104
10105 Example:
10106
10107 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10108 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10109
10110At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10111
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010112 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +010010113 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010114
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010115the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010116
10117 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010118 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010119 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
10120
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010121and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10122
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010123 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010124 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10125
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010126Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10127
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010128 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010129 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010130 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10131 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10132 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10133 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010134 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010135 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010136 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +010010137 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010138 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
10139 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
10140 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010141 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010142 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
10143 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
10144 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010145 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010146 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010147 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10148 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010149 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010150 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
10151 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
10152 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
10153 | | %b | backend_name | string |
10154 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
10155 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010156 | H | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
10157 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
10158 | H | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010159 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010160 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010161 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010162 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
10163 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
10164 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
10165 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010166 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010167 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010168 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010169 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
10170 | | %s | server_name | string |
10171 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
10172 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010173 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
10174 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
10175 | H | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010176 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010177 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010178 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010179 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010180
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010181 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101838.3. Advanced logging options
10184-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010185
10186Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
10187just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
10188options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
10189for more information about their usage.
10190
10191
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101928.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
10193------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010194
10195It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
10196haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
10197commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
10198monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
10199ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
10200
10201 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
10202 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
10203 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
10204 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
10205
10206 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
10207 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
10208 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
10209 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
10210 such as other load-balancers.
10211
10212 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
10213 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
10214 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
10215
10216
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102178.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
10218----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010219
10220The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
10221what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
10222or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
10223"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
10224just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
10225log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
10226after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
10227is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
10228with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
10229with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
10230
10231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102328.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
10233------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010234
10235Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
10236for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
10237"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
10238retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
10239raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
10240a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
10241file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
10242you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
10243"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
10244
10245
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102468.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
10247--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010248
10249Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
10250multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
10251them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
10252"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
10253logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
10254error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
10255and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
10256too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
10257useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
10258alternative.
10259
10260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102618.4. Timing events
10262------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010263
10264Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
10265reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
10266the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
10267frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
10268mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
10269
10270 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
10271 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
10272 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
10273 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
10274 the client closes prematurely or times out.
10275
10276 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
10277 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
10278 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
10279 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
10280 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
10281
10282 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
10283 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
10284 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
10285 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
10286 connection never established.
10287
10288 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
10289 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
10290 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
10291 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
10292 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
10293 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
10294 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
10295 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
10296 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
10297 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
10298 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
10299
10300 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
10301 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
10302 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
10303 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
10304 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
10305
10306 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
10307
10308 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
10309 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
10310 negative.
10311
10312These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
10313protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
10314that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010315due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010316close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
10317session has been aborted on timeout.
10318
10319Most common cases :
10320
10321 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10322 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
10323 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
10324 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
10325 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
10326 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
10327 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
10328 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
10329 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020010330 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
10331 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
10332 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010333
10334 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10335 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
10336 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
10337 of ms on remote networks.
10338
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010339 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
10340 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
10341 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010342
10343 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
10344 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
10345 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
10346 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
10347 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
10348 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
10349 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
10350 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
10351 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
10352 to the server until another one is released.
10353
10354Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
10355
10356 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
10357 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
10358 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
10359
10360 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
10361 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
10362 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
10363
10364 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
10365 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
10366 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
10367 flags.
10368
10369 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
10370 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
10371 Check the session termination flags, then check the
10372 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
10373 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
10374 the client connection was maintained open.
10375
10376 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
10377 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
10378 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
10379 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
10380
10381
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103828.5. Session state at disconnection
10383-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010384
10385TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
10386"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
103872-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
10388each of which has a special meaning :
10389
10390 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
10391 session to terminate :
10392
10393 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
10394
10395 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
10396 server explicitly refused it.
10397
10398 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
10399 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
10400 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
10401 error in server response which might have caused information leak
10402 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
10403 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
10404
10405 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
10406 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
10407 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
10408 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
10409 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
10410
10411 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
10412 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
10413 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
10414 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
10415 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
10416
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090010417 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
10418 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
10419
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010420 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
10421 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
10422 backup connections when going up.
10423
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020010424 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
10425
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010426 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
10427 send or receive data.
10428
10429 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
10430 send or receive data.
10431
10432 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
10433 with nothing left in the buffers.
10434
10435 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
10436
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010010437 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010438 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
10439
10440 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
10441 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
10442 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
10443 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
10444 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
10445
10446 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
10447 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
10448
10449 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
10450 server (HTTP only).
10451
10452 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
10453
10454 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
10455 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
10456 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
10457
10458 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
10459 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
10460 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
10461
10462 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
10463
10464 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
10465 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
10466
10467 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
10468 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
10469 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
10470
10471 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
10472 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020010473 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
10474 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010475
10476 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
10477 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
10478 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
10479 another server.
10480
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010481 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010482 server.
10483
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010484 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
10485 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
10486 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
10487 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10488
10489 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
10490 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
10491 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
10492 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10493
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020010494 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
10495 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
10496 "use-server" rule).
10497
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010498 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10499
10500 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
10501 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
10502
10503 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
10504
10505 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
10506 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
10507 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
10508
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010509 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
10510 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
10511 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
10512 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
10513 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
10514
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010515 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
10516
10517 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
10518 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
10519
10520 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
10521
10522 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10523
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010524The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
10525was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010526helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
10527starvation, attacks, etc...
10528
10529The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
10530alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
10531easier finding and understanding.
10532
10533 Flags Reason
10534
10535 -- Normal termination.
10536
10537 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
10538 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
10539 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
10540 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
10541
10542 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
10543 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
10544 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
10545 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
10546 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
10547 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010548
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010549 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10550 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010551 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010552
10553 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
10554 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
10555 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
10556
10557 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
10558 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
10559 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
10560 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
10561 the server takes too long to respond.
10562
10563 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
10564 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
10565 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
10566 long a time to respond.
10567
10568 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
10569 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
10570 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
10571 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
10572 and the client.
10573
10574 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
10575 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
10576 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
10577 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
10578 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
10579 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
10580
10581 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
10582 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010583 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
10584 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
10585 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
10586 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010587
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010588 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010589 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
10590 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
10591 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
10592 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
10593 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
10594
10595 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
10596 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
10597 503 or 504 here.
10598
10599 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
10600 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
10601 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
10602 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
10603 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
10604
10605 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10606 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010607 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010608 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
10609 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
10610
10611 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
10612 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
10613 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
10614 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
10615 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
10616 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
10617 between haproxy and the server.
10618
10619 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
10620 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
10621 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
10622 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
10623 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
10624 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
10625 solution is to fix the application.
10626
10627 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
10628 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
10629 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
10630 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
10631 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
10632 external attacks.
10633
10634 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
10635 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010636 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010637 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
10638 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
10639
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010640 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
10641 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
10642 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
10643 the client.
10644
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010645 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
10646 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
10647 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
10648 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010649 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
10650 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
10651 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
10652 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
10653 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010654
10655 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
10656 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
10657 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
10658 returned an HTTP 403 error.
10659
10660 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
10661 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
10662 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
10663 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
10664
10665 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
10666 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
10667 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
10668 only be solved by proper system tuning.
10669
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010670The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
10671persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
10672important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
10673re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
10674
10675 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
10676
10677 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10678 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
10679 set on a GET request.
10680
10681 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
10682 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010683 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010684 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
10685
10686 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
10687 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
10688 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
10689
10690 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10691 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
10692 already got a cookie.
10693
10694 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10695 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
10696 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
10697 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
10698 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
10699
10700 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10701 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10702 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10703
10704 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
10705 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10706 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10707
10708 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
10709 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
10710
10711 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
10712 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
10713 then advertised in the response.
10714
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010715
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107168.6. Non-printable characters
10717-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010718
10719In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
10720consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
10721converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
10722prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
10723being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
10724escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
10725is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
10726'}' when logging headers.
10727
10728Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
10729issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
10730containing spaces is "User-Agent".
10731
10732Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
10733the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
10734performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
10735
10736
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107378.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
10738---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010739
10740Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
10741achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010742section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010743cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
10744the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
10745the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010746locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010747not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
10748user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
10749a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
10750wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
10751
10752 Examples :
10753 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
10754 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
10755
10756 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
10757 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
10758
10759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107608.8. Capturing HTTP headers
10761---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010762
10763Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
10764proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
10765the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
10766server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
10767
10768Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
10769response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010770section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010771
10772It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010773time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
10774appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010775are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
10776and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
10777follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
10778request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
10779in the logs.
10780
10781 Example :
10782 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
10783 listen proxy-out
10784 mode http
10785 option httplog
10786 option logasap
10787 log global
10788 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
10789
10790 # log the name of the virtual server
10791 capture request header Host len 20
10792
10793 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
10794 capture request header Content-Length len 10
10795
10796 # log the beginning of the referrer
10797 capture request header Referer len 20
10798
10799 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
10800 capture response header Server len 20
10801
10802 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
10803 capture response header Content-Length len 10
10804
10805 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
10806 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
10807
10808 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
10809 capture response header Via len 20
10810
10811 # log the URL location during a redirection
10812 capture response header Location len 20
10813
10814 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
10815 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
10816 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10817 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
10818 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
10819
10820 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10821 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10822 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10823 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010824 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010825
10826 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10827 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10828 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10829 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
10830 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010831 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010832
10833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108348.9. Examples of logs
10835---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010836
10837These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
10838them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
10839reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
10840
10841 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
10842 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10843 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10844
10845 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
10846 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
10847
10848 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
10849 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
10850 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10851
10852 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
10853 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
10854
10855 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
10856 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10857 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10858
10859 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010860 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010861 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
10862 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
10863
10864 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
10865 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
10866 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
10867
10868 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
10869 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010870 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010871 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
10872 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
10873 to return the 502 and not the server.
10874
10875 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010876 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010877
10878 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
10879 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
10880 Nothing was sent to any server.
10881
10882 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
10883 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
10884
10885 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
10886 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
10887 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
10888 send a 408 return code to the client.
10889
10890 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
10891 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
10892
10893 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
10894 5 seconds ("c----").
10895
10896 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
10897 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010898 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010899
10900 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010901 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010902 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
10903 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
10904 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
10905 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
10906 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010907
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109099. Statistics and monitoring
10910----------------------------
10911
10912It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
10913mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
10914CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
10915Unix socket.
10916
10917
109189.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010919---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010920
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010010921The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
10922page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
10923
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010924 0. pxname: proxy name
10925 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
10926 for server)
10927 2. qcur: current queued requests
10928 3. qmax: max queued requests
10929 4. scur: current sessions
10930 5. smax: max sessions
10931 6. slim: sessions limit
10932 7. stot: total sessions
10933 8. bin: bytes in
10934 9. bout: bytes out
10935 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010936 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010937 12. ereq: request errors
10938 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010939 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010940 15. wretr: retries (warning)
10941 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010010942 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010943 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
10944 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
10945 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
10946 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
10947 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
10948 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
10949 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
10950 25. qlimit: queue limit
10951 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
10952 27. iid: unique proxy id
10953 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
10954 29. throttle: warm up status
10955 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
10956 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010957 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020010958 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
10959 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
10960 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010961 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010962 UNK -> unknown
10963 INI -> initializing
10964 SOCKERR -> socket error
10965 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
10966 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
10967 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
10968 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
10969 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
10970 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10971 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10972 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
10973 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
10974 disable-on-404
10975 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10976 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10977 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010978 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
10979 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010980 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
10981 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
10982 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
10983 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
10984 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
10985 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010986 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
10987 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
10988 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
10989 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010990 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
10991 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010992
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109949.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010995-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010996
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010997The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010998must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
10999is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
11000a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
11001risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
11002followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
11003given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
11004then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
11005to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011006
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011007It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
11008on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
11009own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011010
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011011clear counters
11012 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
11013 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
11014 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
11015 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
11016 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11017
11018clear counters all
11019 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
11020 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
11021 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
11022
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011023clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
11024 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
11025
11026 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
11027 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
11028 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
11029 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
11030 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
11031 later after the session ends is usual enough.
11032
11033 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
11034
11035 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
11036 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
11037 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
11038 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
11039 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
11040 the ACLs :
11041
11042 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11043 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11044 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11045 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11046 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11047 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11048
11049 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011050 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
11051 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011052
11053 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011054 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011055 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011056 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11057 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11058 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11059 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011060
11061 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11062
11063 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011064 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011065 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11066 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011067 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11068 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11069 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011070
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011071disable frontend <frontend>
11072 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
11073 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
11074 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
11075 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
11076 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
11077 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
11078 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
11079 on the stats page.
11080
11081 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11082 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11083
11084 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11085 level "admin".
11086
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011087disable server <backend>/<server>
11088 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
11089 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
11090 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
11091 during the maintenance.
11092
11093 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
11094 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
11095
11096 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011097 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011098
11099 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11100 level "admin".
11101
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011102enable frontend <frontend>
11103 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
11104 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
11105 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
11106 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
11107 which was disabled.
11108
11109 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11110 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11111
11112 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11113 level "admin".
11114
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011115enable server <backend>/<server>
11116 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
11117 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
11118
11119 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011120 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011121
11122 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11123 level "admin".
11124
11125get weight <backend>/<server>
11126 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
11127 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
11128 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
11129 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
11130 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011131 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011132
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011133help
11134 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
11135 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011136
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011137prompt
11138 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
11139 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
11140 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
11141 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
11142 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
11143 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
11144 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
11145 command.
11146
11147quit
11148 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011149
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011150set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020011151 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
11152 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
11153 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
11154 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
11155 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011156 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
11157 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11158
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020011159set maxconn global <maxconn>
11160 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
11161 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
11162 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
11163 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
11164 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
11165 setting.
11166
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020011167set rate-limit connections global <value>
11168 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
11169 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
11170 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
11171 is passed in number of connections per second.
11172
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011173set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
11174 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
11175 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
11176 passed in number of kilobytes per second.
11177
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020011178set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
11179 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
11180 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
11181 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
11182 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
11183 IP address or affect its quality of service.
11184
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011185set timeout cli <delay>
11186 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
11187 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
11188 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
11189
11190set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
11191 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
11192 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
11193 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
11194 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
11195 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
11196 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
11197 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
11198 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
11199 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
11200 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
11201 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
11202 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
11203 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011204 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011205
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011206show errors [<iid>]
11207 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
11208 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011209 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
11210 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
11211 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011212
11213 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
11214 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
11215 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
11216 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
11217 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
11218 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
11219 are reported too.
11220
11221 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
11222 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
11223 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
11224 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
11225 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
11226 code.
11227
11228 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
11229 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
11230 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
11231 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
11232 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
11233 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
11234 line.
11235
11236 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011237 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11238 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011239 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
11240 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
11241
11242 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
11243 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
11244 00038 Location: blah\r\n
11245 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
11246 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
11247 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
11248 00204+ minal\r\n
11249 00211 \r\n
11250
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011251 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011252 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
11253 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
11254 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
11255 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
11256 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
11257 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011258
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011259show info
11260 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
11261
11262show sess
11263 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011264 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
11265 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11266
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010011267show sess <id>
11268 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
11269 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11270 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
11271 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
11272 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
11273 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011274
11275show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
11276 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
11277 possible to dump only selected items :
11278 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
11279 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
11280 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
11281 for example:
11282 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
11283 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
11284 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
11285
11286 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011287 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
11288 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011289 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
11290 Release_date: 2009/09/23
11291 Nbproc: 1
11292 Process_num: 1
11293 (...)
11294
11295 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
11296 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
11297 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
11298 (...)
11299 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
11300
11301 $
11302
11303 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
11304 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
11305 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
11306 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011307 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011308
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011309show table
11310 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
11311 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
11312 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
11313 entries currently in use.
11314
11315 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011316 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011317 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
11318 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011319
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011320show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011321 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
11322 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
11323 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011324 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
11325
11326 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
11327 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
11328 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
11329 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
11330 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
11331
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011332 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11333 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11334 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11335 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11336 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11337 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11338
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011339
11340 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011341 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
11342 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011343
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011344 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011345 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011346 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011347 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11348 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11349 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11350 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011351
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011352 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011353 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011354 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11355 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011356
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011357 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
11358 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011359 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011360 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11361 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011362
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011363 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
11364 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011365 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011366 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11367 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
11368
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011369 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
11370 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
11371 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
11372 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
11373 time goes, the average event rate drops.
11374
11375 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
11376 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
11377 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011378 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
11379 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011380 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
11381 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020011382
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011383shutdown frontend <frontend>
11384 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
11385 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
11386 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
11387 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
11388 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
11389 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
11390 once it is terminated.
11391
11392 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11393 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11394
11395 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11396 level "admin".
11397
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020011398shutdown session <id>
11399 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
11400 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11401 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
11402 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
11403 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
11404 flag in the logs.
11405
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020011406shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
11407 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
11408 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
11409 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
11410 'K' flag in the logs.
11411
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011412/*
11413 * Local variables:
11414 * fill-column: 79
11415 * End:
11416 */